1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 //  This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
15 #include "TreeTransform.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
45 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h"
46 using namespace clang;
47 using namespace sema;
48 
49 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
50 /// emitting diagnostics.
51 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
52   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
53   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
54     return false;
55 
56   // See if this is a deleted function.
57   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
58     if (FD->isDeleted())
59       return false;
60 
61     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
62     // then we can't use it either.
63     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
64         DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false))
65       return false;
66   }
67 
68   // See if this function is unavailable.
69   if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable &&
70       cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
71     return false;
72 
73   return true;
74 }
75 
76 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
77   // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
78   if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
79     const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext());
80     if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
81       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
82   }
83 }
84 
85 static AvailabilityResult DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S,
86                               NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
87                               const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
88                               bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
89   // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated.
90   std::string Message;
91 
92   // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition.
93   if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
94     if (IDecl->getDefinition())
95       D = IDecl->getDefinition();
96   }
97   AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
98   if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D))
99     if (Result == AR_Available) {
100       const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext();
101       if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC))
102         Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message);
103     }
104 
105   const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr;
106   if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable) {
107     if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
108       if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) {
109         AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr);
110         if (PDeclResult == Result)
111           ObjCPDecl = PD;
112       }
113     }
114   }
115 
116   switch (Result) {
117     case AR_Available:
118     case AR_NotYetIntroduced:
119       break;
120 
121     case AR_Deprecated:
122       if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated)
123         S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation,
124                                   D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
125                                   ObjCPropertyAccess);
126       break;
127 
128     case AR_Unavailable:
129       if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
130         S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable,
131                                   D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
132                                   ObjCPropertyAccess);
133       break;
134 
135     }
136     return Result;
137 }
138 
139 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
140 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) {
141   assert(Decl->isDeleted());
142 
143   CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl);
144 
145   if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) {
146     // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration.
147     if (!Method->isImplicit())
148       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted);
149 
150     // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly
151     // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies.
152     CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method);
153     if (CSM != CXXInvalid)
154       ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true);
155 
156     return;
157   }
158 
159   if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) {
160     if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD =
161             const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) {
162       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here);
163       if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) {
164         NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD);
165       } else {
166         // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited
167         // would be nice.
168         Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit);
169       }
170       return;
171     }
172   }
173 
174   Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here)
175     << Decl << true;
176 }
177 
178 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an
179 /// explicit storage class.
180 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) {
181   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
182     if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None)
183       return true;
184   }
185   return false;
186 }
187 
188 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a
189 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3).
190 ///
191 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but
192 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode
193 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6)
194 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't
195 /// prove that there are errors.
196 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S,
197                                                       const NamedDecl *D,
198                                                       SourceLocation Loc) {
199   // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in
200   // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically
201   // correct but benign.
202   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
203     return;
204 
205   // Check if this is an inlined function or method.
206   FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl();
207   if (!Current)
208     return;
209   if (!Current->isInlined())
210     return;
211   if (!Current->isExternallyVisible())
212     return;
213 
214   // Check if the decl has internal linkage.
215   if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage)
216     return;
217 
218   // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if
219   //  (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file,
220   //      and probably won't be included anywhere else.
221   //  (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function.
222   //  (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function.
223   // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on
224   // wrappers for simple C library functions.
225   const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
226   bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc);
227   if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn)
228     DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>();
229 
230   S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet
231                                : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline)
232     << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D;
233 
234   S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current);
235 
236   S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
237       << D;
238 }
239 
240 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) {
241   const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl();
242 
243   // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible.
244   if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) {
245     SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin();
246     Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static)
247       << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static ");
248   }
249 }
250 
251 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
252 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
253 ///
254 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
255 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
256 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
257 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
258 /// function is being used.
259 ///
260 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
261 /// referenced), false otherwise.
262 ///
263 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
264                              const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
265                              bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
266   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
267     // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
268     // emit them now.
269     SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator
270       Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
271     if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
272       SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
273       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
274         Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
275 
276       // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
277       // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
278       // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
279       // diagnostics again.
280       Suppressed.clear();
281     }
282 
283     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3:
284     //   The function 'main' shall not be used within a program.
285     if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain())
286       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used);
287   }
288 
289   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
290   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
291     Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
292       << D->getDeclName();
293     return true;
294   }
295 
296   // See if this is a deleted function.
297   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
298     if (FD->isDeleted()) {
299       Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
300       NoteDeletedFunction(FD);
301       return true;
302     }
303 
304     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
305     // then we can't use it either.
306     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
307         DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc))
308       return true;
309   }
310   DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess);
311 
312   DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc);
313 
314   diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc);
315 
316   return false;
317 }
318 
319 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a
320 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or
321 /// unavailable.
322 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
323   std::string Message;
324   if (FD->getAvailability(&Message))
325     return ": " + Message;
326 
327   return std::string();
328 }
329 
330 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
331 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
332 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
333 /// satisfied.
334 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
335                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
336   const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
337   if (!attr)
338     return;
339 
340   // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
341   unsigned numFormalParams;
342 
343   // The kind of declaration.  This is also an index into a %select in
344   // the diagnostic.
345   enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType;
346 
347   if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
348     numFormalParams = MD->param_size();
349     calleeType = CT_Method;
350   } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
351     numFormalParams = FD->param_size();
352     calleeType = CT_Function;
353   } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
354     QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType();
355     const FunctionType *fn = nullptr;
356     if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
357       fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
358       if (!fn) return;
359       calleeType = CT_Function;
360     } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
361       fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
362       calleeType = CT_Block;
363     } else {
364       return;
365     }
366 
367     if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) {
368       numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams();
369     } else {
370       numFormalParams = 0;
371     }
372   } else {
373     return;
374   }
375 
376   // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
377   // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments.  This is
378   // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
379   // but the language forces you to have at least one.
380   unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
381   assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
382   numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos);
383 
384   // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
385   unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel();
386 
387   // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
388   // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
389   if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
390     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
391     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
392     return;
393   }
394 
395   // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
396   Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
397   if (!sentinelExpr) return;
398   if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
399   if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return;
400 
401   // Pick a reasonable string to insert.  Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr',
402   // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context.  Only use
403   // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
404   // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
405   SourceLocation MissingNilLoc
406     = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd());
407   std::string NullValue;
408   if (calleeType == CT_Method &&
409       PP.getIdentifierInfo("nil")->hasMacroDefinition())
410     NullValue = "nil";
411   else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
412     NullValue = "nullptr";
413   else if (PP.getIdentifierInfo("NULL")->hasMacroDefinition())
414     NullValue = "NULL";
415   else
416     NullValue = "(void*) 0";
417 
418   if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
419     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType);
420   else
421     Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
422       << int(calleeType)
423       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
424   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
425 }
426 
427 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
428   return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
429 }
430 
431 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
432 //  Standard Promotions and Conversions
433 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
434 
435 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
436 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) {
437   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
438   if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
439     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
440     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
441     E = result.get();
442   }
443 
444   QualType Ty = E->getType();
445   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
446 
447   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
448     // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking
449     // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3).
450     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
451       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
452       return ExprError();
453     }
454     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
455                           CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
456   } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
457     // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
458     // an lvalue.  The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
459     // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
460     // to type'...".  In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
461     // that has type 'array of type' ...".  The relevant change is "an lvalue"
462     // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
463     //
464     // C++ 4.2p1:
465     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
466     // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
467     //
468     if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
469       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
470                             CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
471   }
472   return E;
473 }
474 
475 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
476   // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer.  If so,
477   // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
478   // optimizer will delete, so warn about it.  People sometimes try to use this
479   // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior.  This
480   // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
481   if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
482     if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
483         UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
484           isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
485         !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
486     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
487                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
488                             << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
489     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
490                         S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
491   }
492 }
493 
494 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE,
495                                     SourceLocation AssignLoc,
496                                     const Expr* RHS) {
497   const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl();
498   if (!IV)
499     return;
500 
501   DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName();
502   IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
503   if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa"))
504     return;
505 
506   const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase();
507   QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
508   if (OIRE->isArrow())
509     BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType();
510   if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
511     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) {
512       ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr;
513       ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
514       if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass()
515           && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) {
516         if (RHS) {
517           NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass =
518             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
519                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
520                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
521           if (ObjectSetClass) {
522             SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd());
523             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
524             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
525             FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
526                                                      AssignLoc), ",") <<
527             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
528           }
529           else
530             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
531         } else {
532           NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass =
533             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
534                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
535                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
536           if (ObjectGetClass)
537             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
538             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
539             FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
540                                          SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
541                                                      OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")");
542           else
543             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
544         }
545         S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl);
546       }
547     }
548 }
549 
550 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
551   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
552   if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
553     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
554     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
555     E = result.get();
556   }
557 
558   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
559   //   A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
560   //   converted to a prvalue.
561   if (!E->isGLValue()) return E;
562 
563   QualType T = E->getType();
564   assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
565 
566   // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
567   // expressions of certain types in C++.
568   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
569       (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
570        T->isDependentType() ||
571        T->isRecordType()))
572     return E;
573 
574   // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
575   // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why.  It's
576   // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
577   // lvalue-to-rvalue at all.  Note that expressions of unqualified
578   // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
579   if (T->isVoidType())
580     return E;
581 
582   // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type.
583   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 &&
584       T->isHalfType()) {
585     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store)
586       << 0 << T;
587     return ExprError();
588   }
589 
590   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
591   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
592     NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
593                                      &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
594                                      SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
595     if (ObjectGetClass)
596       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
597         FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
598         FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
599                     SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")");
600     else
601       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
602   }
603   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
604             dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
605     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr);
606 
607   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
608   //   [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
609   //   cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
610   //   rvalue is T.
611   //
612   // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
613   //   If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
614   //   version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
615   //   type of the lvalue.
616   if (T.hasQualifiers())
617     T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
618 
619   UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E);
620 
621   // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to
622   // balance that.
623   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
624       E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
625     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
626 
627   ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E,
628                                             nullptr, VK_RValue);
629 
630   // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
631   //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
632   //   of the type of the lvalue ...
633   if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) {
634     T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType();
635     Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(),
636                                    nullptr, VK_RValue);
637   }
638 
639   return Res;
640 }
641 
642 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
643   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
644   if (Res.isInvalid())
645     return ExprError();
646   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
647   if (Res.isInvalid())
648     return ExprError();
649   return Res;
650 }
651 
652 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion
653 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression.
654 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
655   QualType Ty = E->getType();
656   ExprResult Res = E;
657   // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer
658   // to function type.
659   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
660     Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
661                             CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
662     if (Res.isInvalid())
663       return ExprError();
664   }
665   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
666   if (Res.isInvalid())
667     return ExprError();
668   return Res.get();
669 }
670 
671 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
672 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
673 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
674 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
675 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
676 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
677   // First, convert to an r-value.
678   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
679   if (Res.isInvalid())
680     return ExprError();
681   E = Res.get();
682 
683   QualType Ty = E->getType();
684   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
685 
686   // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
687   if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
688     return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
689 
690   // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
691   // promotable type.
692   if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
693     // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
694     //
695     //   The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
696     //   unsigned int may be used:
697     //     - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
698     //       conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
699     //       and unsigned int.
700     //     - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
701     //
702     //   If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
703     //   value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
704     //   unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
705     //   other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
706 
707     QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
708     if (!PTy.isNull()) {
709       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
710       return E;
711     }
712     if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
713       QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
714       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get();
715       return E;
716     }
717   }
718   return E;
719 }
720 
721 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
722 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16
723 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by
724 /// UsualUnaryConversions().
725 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
726   QualType Ty = E->getType();
727   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
728 
729   ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
730   if (Res.isInvalid())
731     return ExprError();
732   E = Res.get();
733 
734   // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to
735   // double.
736   const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
737   if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half ||
738               BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float))
739     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
740 
741   // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
742   // promotion, even on class types, but note:
743   //   C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
744   //     When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
745   //     operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
746   //     referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
747   //     has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
748   //     of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
749   //     is a prvalue for the temporary.
750   // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
751   // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
752   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
753     ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
754                        InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
755                                                 E->getExprLoc(), E);
756     if (Temp.isInvalid())
757       return ExprError();
758     E = Temp.get();
759   }
760 
761   return E;
762 }
763 
764 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
765 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed
766 /// when we're in an unevaluated context.
767 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) {
768   if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) {
769     // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
770     //   After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic,
771     //   enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program
772     //   is ill-formed.
773     //
774     // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer
775     // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles
776     // initializer lists as variadic arguments.
777     if (Ty->isVoidType())
778       return VAK_Invalid;
779 
780     if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
781       return VAK_Invalid;
782     return VAK_Valid;
783   }
784 
785   if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context))
786     return VAK_Valid;
787 
788   // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
789   //   Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
790   //   having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
791   //   or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
792   //   is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
793   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType())
794     if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
795       if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
796           !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
797           !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
798         return VAK_ValidInCXX11;
799 
800   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType())
801     return VAK_Valid;
802 
803   if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
804     return VAK_Invalid;
805 
806   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
807     return VAK_MSVCUndefined;
808 
809   // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're
810   // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so.
811   return VAK_Undefined;
812 }
813 
814 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) {
815   // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
816   const QualType &Ty = E->getType();
817   VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty);
818 
819   // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs.
820   switch (VAK) {
821   case VAK_ValidInCXX11:
822     DiagRuntimeBehavior(
823         E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
824         PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
825           << Ty << CT);
826     // Fall through.
827   case VAK_Valid:
828     if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
829       // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a
830       // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that.
831       DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
832                           PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg)
833                             << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()");
834     }
835     break;
836 
837   case VAK_Undefined:
838   case VAK_MSVCUndefined:
839     DiagRuntimeBehavior(
840         E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
841         PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
842           << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT);
843     break;
844 
845   case VAK_Invalid:
846     if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
847       DiagRuntimeBehavior(
848           E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
849           PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
850             << Ty << CT);
851     else
852       Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg)
853         << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT;
854     break;
855   }
856 }
857 
858 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
859 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type.
860 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
861                                                   FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
862   if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
863     // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
864     if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
865         (CT == VariadicMethod ||
866          (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) {
867       E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
868 
869     // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking.
870     } else {
871       ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
872       if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
873         return ExprError();
874       E = ExprRes.get();
875     }
876   }
877 
878   ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
879   if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
880     return ExprError();
881   E = ExprRes.get();
882 
883   // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are
884   // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall().
885   if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) {
886     // Turn this into a trap.
887     CXXScopeSpec SS;
888     SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
889     UnqualifiedId Name;
890     Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
891                        E->getLocStart());
892     ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc,
893                                           Name, true, false);
894     if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
895       return ExprError();
896 
897     ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(),
898                                     E->getLocStart(), None,
899                                     E->getLocEnd());
900     if (Call.isInvalid())
901       return ExprError();
902 
903     ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma,
904                                   Call.get(), E);
905     if (Comma.isInvalid())
906       return ExprError();
907     return Comma.get();
908   }
909 
910   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
911       RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(),
912                           diag::err_call_incomplete_argument))
913     return ExprError();
914 
915   return E;
916 }
917 
918 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type.  Helper function of
919 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
920 ///
921 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
922 /// successfully converted to the complex type.
923 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
924                                                   ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
925                                                   QualType IntTy,
926                                                   QualType ComplexTy,
927                                                   bool SkipCast) {
928   if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
929   if (SkipCast) return false;
930   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
931     QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
932     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
933     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
934                                   CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
935   } else {
936     assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
937     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
938                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
939   }
940   return false;
941 }
942 
943 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types.  Helper function of
944 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
945 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
946                                              ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
947                                              QualType RHSType,
948                                              bool IsCompAssign) {
949   // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
950   if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
951                                              /*skipCast*/false))
952     return LHSType;
953   if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
954                                              /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign))
955     return RHSType;
956 
957   // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
958   // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
959   // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
960   // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
961   // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
962   // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
963   // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
964   // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
965   // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
966   // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
967 
968   // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex.
969   int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
970 
971   auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType);
972   auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType);
973   QualType LHSElementType =
974       LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType;
975   QualType RHSElementType =
976       RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType;
977 
978   QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType);
979   if (Order < 0) {
980     // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment.
981     ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType);
982     if (!IsCompAssign) {
983       if (LHSComplexType)
984         LHS =
985             S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
986       else
987         LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
988     }
989   } else if (Order > 0) {
990     // Promote the precision of the RHS.
991     if (RHSComplexType)
992       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
993     else
994       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
995   }
996   return ResultType;
997 }
998 
999 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float.  Helper function
1000 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1001 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
1002                                            ExprResult &IntExpr,
1003                                            QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
1004                                            bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
1005   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
1006     if (ConvertInt)
1007       // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
1008       IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy,
1009                                     CK_IntegralToFloating);
1010     return FloatTy;
1011   }
1012 
1013   // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
1014   assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
1015   QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
1016 
1017   // _Complex int -> _Complex float
1018   if (ConvertInt)
1019     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result,
1020                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
1021 
1022   // float -> _Complex float
1023   if (ConvertFloat)
1024     FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result,
1025                                     CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
1026 
1027   return result;
1028 }
1029 
1030 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types.  Helper
1031 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1032 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1033                                       ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1034                                       QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1035   bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1036   bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1037 
1038   // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
1039   // to the bigger result.
1040   if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
1041     int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1042     if (order > 0) {
1043       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1044       return LHSType;
1045     }
1046 
1047     assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
1048     if (!IsCompAssign)
1049       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1050     return RHSType;
1051   }
1052 
1053   if (LHSFloat)
1054     return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1055                                       /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
1056                                       /*convertInt=*/ true);
1057   assert(RHSFloat);
1058   return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1059                                     /*convertInt=*/ true,
1060                                     /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign);
1061 }
1062 
1063 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType);
1064 
1065 namespace {
1066 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to
1067 /// permit their use as function template parameters.
1068 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1069   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast);
1070 }
1071 
1072 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1073   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType),
1074                              CK_IntegralComplexCast);
1075 }
1076 }
1077 
1078 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions.  Helper function of
1079 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
1080 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast>
1081 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1082                                         ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1083                                         QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1084   // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
1085   int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1086   bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1087   bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1088   if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
1089     // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
1090     if (order >= 0) {
1091       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1092       return LHSType;
1093     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1094       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1095     return RHSType;
1096   } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
1097     // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
1098     // signed type, so use the unsigned type
1099     if (RHSSigned) {
1100       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1101       return LHSType;
1102     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1103       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1104     return RHSType;
1105   } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
1106     // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
1107     // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
1108     // use the signed type.
1109     if (LHSSigned) {
1110       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1111       return LHSType;
1112     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1113       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1114     return RHSType;
1115   } else {
1116     // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
1117     // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
1118     // on most 32-bit systems).  Use the unsigned type corresponding
1119     // to the signed type.
1120     QualType result =
1121       S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
1122     RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result);
1123     if (!IsCompAssign)
1124       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result);
1125     return result;
1126   }
1127 }
1128 
1129 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension.  Helper function
1130 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1131 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1132                                            ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1133                                            QualType RHSType,
1134                                            bool IsCompAssign) {
1135   const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1136   const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1137 
1138   if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
1139     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1140     QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1141     QualType ScalarType =
1142       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1143         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1144 
1145     return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1146   }
1147 
1148   if (LHSComplexInt) {
1149     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1150     QualType ScalarType =
1151       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1152         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1153     QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1154     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType,
1155                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1156 
1157     return ComplexType;
1158   }
1159 
1160   assert(RHSComplexInt);
1161 
1162   QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1163   QualType ScalarType =
1164     handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1165       (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1166   QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1167 
1168   if (!IsCompAssign)
1169     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType,
1170                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1171   return ComplexType;
1172 }
1173 
1174 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
1175 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
1176 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
1177 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
1178 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
1179                                           bool IsCompAssign) {
1180   if (!IsCompAssign) {
1181     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
1182     if (LHS.isInvalid())
1183       return QualType();
1184   }
1185 
1186   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
1187   if (RHS.isInvalid())
1188     return QualType();
1189 
1190   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
1191   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
1192   QualType LHSType =
1193     Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1194   QualType RHSType =
1195     Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1196 
1197   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS.
1198   if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1199     LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType();
1200 
1201   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1202   if (LHSType == RHSType)
1203     return LHSType;
1204 
1205   // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
1206   // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
1207   if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
1208     return QualType();
1209 
1210   // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
1211   QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
1212   if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType())
1213     LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
1214   QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
1215   if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
1216     LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
1217   if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign)
1218     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
1219 
1220   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1221   if (LHSType == RHSType)
1222     return LHSType;
1223 
1224   // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
1225 
1226   // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
1227   if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
1228     return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1229                                         IsCompAssign);
1230 
1231   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
1232   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
1233     return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1234                                  IsCompAssign);
1235 
1236   // Handle GCC complex int extension.
1237   if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
1238     return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1239                                       IsCompAssign);
1240 
1241   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
1242   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1243            (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1244 }
1245 
1246 
1247 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1248 //  Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
1249 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1250 
1251 
1252 ExprResult
1253 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1254                                 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1255                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1256                                 Expr *ControllingExpr,
1257                                 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,
1258                                 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) {
1259   unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
1260   assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
1261 
1262   TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
1263   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1264     if (ArgTypes[i])
1265       (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]);
1266     else
1267       Types[i] = nullptr;
1268   }
1269 
1270   ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1271                                              ControllingExpr,
1272                                              llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs),
1273                                              ArgExprs);
1274   delete [] Types;
1275   return ER;
1276 }
1277 
1278 ExprResult
1279 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1280                                  SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1281                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1282                                  Expr *ControllingExpr,
1283                                  ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types,
1284                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) {
1285   unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size();
1286   assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size());
1287   if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
1288     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr);
1289     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
1290     ControllingExpr = result.get();
1291   }
1292 
1293   // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are
1294   // likely unintended.
1295   if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1296       ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
1297     Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(),
1298          diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
1299 
1300   bool TypeErrorFound = false,
1301        IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(),
1302        ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack
1303          = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
1304 
1305   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1306     if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1307       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1308 
1309     if (Types[i]) {
1310       if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1311         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1312 
1313       if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1314         IsResultDependent = true;
1315       } else {
1316         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
1317         // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
1318         unsigned D = 0;
1319         if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
1320           D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete;
1321         else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
1322           D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
1323         else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
1324           D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
1325 
1326         if (D != 0) {
1327           Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
1328             << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1329             << Types[i]->getType();
1330           TypeErrorFound = true;
1331         }
1332 
1333         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
1334         // selection shall specify compatible types."
1335         for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
1336           if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
1337               Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
1338                                          Types[j]->getType())) {
1339             Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1340                  diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
1341               << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1342               << Types[j]->getType()
1343               << Types[i]->getType();
1344             Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1345                  diag::note_compat_assoc)
1346               << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1347               << Types[i]->getType();
1348             TypeErrorFound = true;
1349           }
1350       }
1351     }
1352   }
1353   if (TypeErrorFound)
1354     return ExprError();
1355 
1356   // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
1357   // try to compute the result expression.
1358   if (IsResultDependent)
1359     return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1360         Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1361         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
1362 
1363   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
1364   unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U;
1365   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1366     if (!Types[i])
1367       DefaultIndex = i;
1368     else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(),
1369                                         Types[i]->getType()))
1370       CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1371   }
1372 
1373   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
1374   // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
1375   // association list."
1376   if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
1377     // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1378     // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1379     ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1380     Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
1381       << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType()
1382       << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size();
1383     for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(),
1384          E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1385       Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1386            diag::note_compat_assoc)
1387         << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1388         << Types[*I]->getType();
1389     }
1390     return ExprError();
1391   }
1392 
1393   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
1394   // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
1395   // the types named in its generic association list."
1396   if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
1397     // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1398     // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1399     ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1400     Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match)
1401       << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType();
1402     return ExprError();
1403   }
1404 
1405   // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
1406   // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
1407   // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
1408   // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
1409   // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
1410   unsigned ResultIndex =
1411     CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
1412 
1413   return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1414       Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1415       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
1416 }
1417 
1418 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the
1419 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it.
1420 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
1421                                      unsigned Offset) {
1422   return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(),
1423                                         S.getLangOpts());
1424 }
1425 
1426 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up
1427 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it.
1428 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope,
1429                                                  IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix,
1430                                                  SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,
1431                                                  ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
1432                                                  SourceLocation LitEndLoc) {
1433   assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator");
1434 
1435   QualType ArgTy[2];
1436   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
1437     ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType();
1438     if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType())
1439       ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]);
1440   }
1441 
1442   DeclarationName OpName =
1443     S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1444   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1445   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1446 
1447   LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
1448   if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()),
1449                               /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1450                               /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error)
1451     return ExprError();
1452 
1453   return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc);
1454 }
1455 
1456 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
1457 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz").  The result string has to handle string
1458 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
1459 /// multiple tokens.  However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
1460 /// string.
1461 ///
1462 ExprResult
1463 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) {
1464   assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!");
1465 
1466   StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP);
1467   if (Literal.hadError)
1468     return ExprError();
1469 
1470   SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
1471   for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i)
1472     StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
1473 
1474   QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy;
1475   StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii;
1476   if (Literal.isWide()) {
1477     CharTy = Context.getWideCharType();
1478     Kind = StringLiteral::Wide;
1479   } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) {
1480     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8;
1481   } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) {
1482     CharTy = Context.Char16Ty;
1483     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16;
1484   } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) {
1485     CharTy = Context.Char32Ty;
1486     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32;
1487   } else if (Literal.isPascal()) {
1488     CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
1489   }
1490 
1491   QualType CharTyConst = CharTy;
1492   // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
1493   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings)
1494     CharTyConst.addConst();
1495 
1496   // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5.  This includes
1497   // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
1498   // strings.
1499   QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst,
1500                                  llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
1501                                  ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1502 
1503   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space.
1504   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
1505     StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant);
1506   }
1507 
1508   // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
1509   StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
1510                                              Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy,
1511                                              &StringTokLocs[0],
1512                                              StringTokLocs.size());
1513   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
1514     return Lit;
1515 
1516   // We're building a user-defined literal.
1517   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
1518   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
1519     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
1520                    Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
1521 
1522   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
1523   if (!UDLScope)
1524     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
1525 
1526   // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
1527   //   operator "" X (str, len)
1528   QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
1529 
1530   DeclarationName OpName =
1531     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1532   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1533   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1534 
1535   QualType ArgTy[] = {
1536     Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType
1537   };
1538 
1539   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1540   switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy,
1541                                 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1542                                 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) {
1543 
1544   case LOLR_Cooked: {
1545     llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars());
1546     IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType,
1547                                                     StringTokLocs[0]);
1548     Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg };
1549 
1550     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back());
1551   }
1552 
1553   case LOLR_StringTemplate: {
1554     TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
1555 
1556     unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy);
1557     bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
1558     llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
1559 
1560     TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy);
1561     TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy));
1562     ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo));
1563 
1564     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) {
1565       Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I);
1566       TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy);
1567       TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
1568       ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
1569     }
1570     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(),
1571                                     &ExplicitArgs);
1572   }
1573   case LOLR_Raw:
1574   case LOLR_Template:
1575     llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1576   case LOLR_Error:
1577     return ExprError();
1578   }
1579   llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1580 }
1581 
1582 ExprResult
1583 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1584                        SourceLocation Loc,
1585                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
1586   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
1587   return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
1588 }
1589 
1590 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
1591 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
1592 ExprResult
1593 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1594                        const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1595                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
1596                        const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1597   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
1598     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
1599       if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1600         if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Callee)) {
1601           Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target)
1602             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) << D->getIdentifier()
1603             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller);
1604           Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1605             << D->getIdentifier();
1606           return ExprError();
1607         }
1608       }
1609 
1610   bool RefersToCapturedVariable =
1611       isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1612       NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc());
1613 
1614   DeclRefExpr *E;
1615   if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
1616     VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
1617         cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D);
1618 
1619     E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1620                                         : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1621                             VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D,
1622                             RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK,
1623                             FoundD, TemplateArgs);
1624   } else {
1625     assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable"
1626                             " template specialization references");
1627     E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1628                                         : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1629                             SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable,
1630                             NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD);
1631   }
1632 
1633   MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
1634 
1635   if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1636       Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak &&
1637       !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart()))
1638       recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E);
1639 
1640   // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
1641   FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
1642   if (FD && FD->isBitField())
1643     E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
1644 
1645   return E;
1646 }
1647 
1648 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
1649 /// possibly a list of template arguments.
1650 ///
1651 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
1652 /// DecomposeTemplateName.
1653 ///
1654 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
1655 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
1656 /// some way.
1657 void
1658 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
1659                              TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
1660                              DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1661                              const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
1662   if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
1663     Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
1664     Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
1665 
1666     ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
1667                                        Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
1668     translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
1669 
1670     TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
1671     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
1672     NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
1673     TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
1674   } else {
1675     NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
1676     TemplateArgs = nullptr;
1677   }
1678 }
1679 
1680 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(
1681     const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1682     DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
1683     unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) {
1684   DeclContext *Ctx =
1685       SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1686   if (!TC) {
1687     // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1688     // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1689     if (Ctx)
1690       SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx
1691                                                  << SS.getRange();
1692     else
1693       SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo;
1694     return;
1695   }
1696 
1697   std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
1698   bool DroppedSpecifier =
1699       TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1700   unsigned NoteID =
1701       (TC.getCorrectionDecl() && isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(TC.getCorrectionDecl()))
1702           ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1703           : diag::note_previous_decl;
1704   if (!Ctx)
1705     SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo,
1706                          SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1707   else
1708     SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1709                                  << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier
1710                                  << SS.getRange(),
1711                          SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1712 }
1713 
1714 /// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1715 ///
1716 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
1717 bool
1718 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1719                           std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
1720                           TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1721                           ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) {
1722   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1723 
1724   unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
1725   unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
1726   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1727       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
1728       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
1729     diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
1730     diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1731   }
1732 
1733   // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1734   // unqualified lookup.  This is useful when (for example) the
1735   // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1736   // dependent name.
1737   DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty())
1738     ? CurContext : nullptr;
1739   while (DC) {
1740     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1741       LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1742 
1743       if (!R.empty()) {
1744         // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1745         R.suppressDiagnostics();
1746 
1747         // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points
1748         // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a
1749         // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check.
1750         bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1751                               ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind ==
1752             ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation;
1753         CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1754         bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1755                           CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1756                           DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument;
1757 
1758 
1759         // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1760         // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1761         // Actually quite difficult!
1762         if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
1763           diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup;
1764         if (isInstance) {
1765           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1766             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1767           UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1768               CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
1769 
1770           CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod;
1771           if (CurMethod->isDependentContext())
1772             DepMethod = CurMethod;
1773           else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() ==
1774               FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization)
1775             DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()->
1776                 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl());
1777           else
1778             DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
1779                 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
1780           assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found");
1781 
1782           QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1783           CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc());
1784           CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1785                                      R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1786           TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1787           if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1788             ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1789 
1790           CXXScopeSpec SS;
1791           SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1792           CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1793               CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1794                   Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1795                   SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1796                   ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr,
1797                   R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1798                   ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr);
1799           CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
1800         } else {
1801           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1802         }
1803 
1804         // Do we really want to note all of these?
1805         for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1806           Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1807 
1808         // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation
1809         // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise
1810         // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an
1811         // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument.
1812         if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) {
1813           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object);
1814           return true;
1815         }
1816 
1817         // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1818         return false;
1819       }
1820 
1821       R.clear();
1822     }
1823 
1824     // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend
1825     // function definition declared at class scope then we must set
1826     // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent
1827     // class.
1828     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) &&
1829         cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1830         DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord())
1831       DC = DC->getLexicalParent();
1832     else
1833       DC = DC->getParent();
1834   }
1835 
1836   // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
1837   TypoCorrection Corrected;
1838   if (S && Out) {
1839     SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc();
1840     assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs &&
1841            "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!");
1842     *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed(
1843         R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC),
1844         [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) {
1845           emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args,
1846                                         diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest);
1847         },
1848         nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
1849     if (*Out)
1850       return true;
1851   } else if (S && (Corrected =
1852                        CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S,
1853                                    &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) {
1854     std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
1855     bool DroppedSpecifier =
1856         Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1857     R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1858 
1859     bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false;
1860     bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false;
1861     NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
1862     if (ND) {
1863       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
1864         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(),
1865                                  OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1866         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
1867         for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
1868                                         CDEnd = Corrected.end();
1869              CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
1870           if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
1871                    dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD))
1872             AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
1873                 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1874                 Args, OCS);
1875           else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
1876             if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
1877               AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
1878                                    Args, OCS);
1879         }
1880         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
1881         case OR_Success:
1882           ND = Best->Function;
1883           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1884           break;
1885         default:
1886           // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note.
1887           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1888           break;
1889         }
1890       }
1891       R.addDecl(ND);
1892       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) {
1893         CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
1894         if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) {
1895           const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType();
1896           Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
1897         }
1898         if (!Record)
1899           Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(
1900               ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext());
1901         R.setNamingClass(Record);
1902       }
1903 
1904       AcceptableWithRecovery =
1905           isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND);
1906       // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1907       // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1908       // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1909       // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1910       // to recover well anyway.
1911       AcceptableWithoutRecovery =
1912           isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
1913     } else {
1914       // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
1915       // because we aren't able to recover.
1916       AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true;
1917     }
1918 
1919     if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) {
1920       unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() &&
1921                          isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()))
1922                             ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1923                             : diag::note_previous_decl;
1924       if (SS.isEmpty())
1925         diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name,
1926                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1927       else
1928         diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1929                                   << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1930                                   << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(),
1931                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1932 
1933       // Tell the callee whether to try to recover.
1934       return !AcceptableWithRecovery;
1935     }
1936   }
1937   R.clear();
1938 
1939   // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1940   // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1941   if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1942     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1943       << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1944       << SS.getRange();
1945     return true;
1946   }
1947 
1948   // Give up, we can't recover.
1949   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1950   return true;
1951 }
1952 
1953 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has
1954 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then
1955 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class.  We can only
1956 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts
1957 /// where 'this' is available.  This doesn't precisely match MSVC's
1958 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough.
1959 static Expr *
1960 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context,
1961                                DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1962                                SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
1963                                const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1964   // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or
1965   // contexts where 'this' is available.
1966   QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType();
1967   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
1968   if (!ThisType.isNull())
1969     RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
1970   else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext))
1971     RD = MD->getParent();
1972   if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases())
1973     return nullptr;
1974 
1975   // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class.  If 'this'
1976   // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit.
1977   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
1978   auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base);
1979   DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD;
1980 
1981   if (!ThisType.isNull()) {
1982     DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->");
1983     return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1984         Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true,
1985         /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc,
1986         /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
1987   }
1988 
1989   // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class.  This will
1990   // perform name lookup during template instantiation.
1991   CXXScopeSpec SS;
1992   auto *NNS =
1993       NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl());
1994   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc));
1995   return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create(
1996       Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
1997       TemplateArgs);
1998 }
1999 
2000 ExprResult
2001 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2002                         SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
2003                         bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2004                         std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
2005                         bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) {
2006   assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
2007          "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
2008   if (SS.isInvalid())
2009     return ExprError();
2010 
2011   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
2012 
2013   // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
2014   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
2015   const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
2016   DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2017 
2018   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
2019   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2020   SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2021 
2022   // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
2023   //   An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
2024   //     -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
2025   //        (note: handled after lookup)
2026   //     -- a template-id that is dependent,
2027   //        (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
2028   //     -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
2029   //     -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
2030   //        names a dependent type.
2031   // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
2032   // we need to handle these differently.
2033   bool DependentID = false;
2034   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
2035       Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
2036     DependentID = true;
2037   } else if (SS.isSet()) {
2038     if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) {
2039       if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2040         return ExprError();
2041     } else {
2042       DependentID = true;
2043     }
2044   }
2045 
2046   if (DependentID)
2047     return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2048                                       IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2049 
2050   // Perform the required lookup.
2051   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
2052                  (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
2053                   ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName);
2054   if (TemplateArgs) {
2055     // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
2056     // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
2057     // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
2058     // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
2059     // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
2060     bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
2061     LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
2062                        MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
2063 
2064     if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization ||
2065         (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation))
2066       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2067                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2068   } else {
2069     bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl();
2070     LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
2071 
2072     // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
2073     // id-expression.
2074     if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2075       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2076                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2077 
2078     // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
2079     // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
2080     if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
2081       ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
2082       if (E.isInvalid())
2083         return ExprError();
2084 
2085       if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>())
2086         return Ex;
2087     }
2088   }
2089 
2090   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2091     return ExprError();
2092 
2093   // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90,
2094   // extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
2095   if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2096     NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
2097     if (D) R.addDecl(D);
2098   }
2099 
2100   // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
2101   // argument-dependent lookup.
2102   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
2103 
2104   if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
2105     if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
2106       if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo,
2107                                                    TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs))
2108         return E;
2109     }
2110 
2111     // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly.
2112     if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier)
2113       return ExprError();
2114 
2115     // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
2116     // call, diagnose the problem.
2117     TypoExpr *TE = nullptr;
2118     auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>(
2119         II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr);
2120     DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand;
2121     assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) &&
2122            "Typo correction callback misconfigured");
2123     if (CCC) {
2124       // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is.
2125       CCC->setTypoName(II);
2126       if (SS.isValid())
2127         CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep());
2128     }
2129     if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R,
2130                             CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator),
2131                             nullptr, None, &TE)) {
2132       if (TE && KeywordReplacement) {
2133         auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE);
2134         auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection();
2135         if (BestTC.isKeyword()) {
2136           auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
2137           if (State.DiagHandler)
2138             State.DiagHandler(BestTC);
2139           KeywordReplacement->startToken();
2140           KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID());
2141           KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II);
2142           KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin());
2143           // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has
2144           // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr).
2145           clearDelayedTypo(TE);
2146           // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a
2147           // valid-but-null ExprResult.
2148           return (Expr*)nullptr;
2149         }
2150         State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream();
2151       }
2152       return TE ? TE : ExprError();
2153     }
2154 
2155     assert(!R.empty() &&
2156            "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
2157 
2158     // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
2159     // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
2160     // reference the ivar.
2161     if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
2162       R.clear();
2163       ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
2164       // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
2165       // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
2166       if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
2167         return ExprError();
2168       return E;
2169     }
2170   }
2171 
2172   // This is guaranteed from this point on.
2173   assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
2174 
2175   // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
2176   // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
2177   //   When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
2178   //   syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
2179   //   body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
2180   //   resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
2181   //   member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
2182   //   class member access expression using (*this) as the
2183   //   postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
2184   //
2185   // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
2186   // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
2187   // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
2188   // non-static member function:
2189   //
2190   // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
2191   //   Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
2192   //   [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
2193   //   member function call.
2194   //
2195   // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
2196   // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
2197   // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
2198   // instance method.
2199   if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
2200     bool MightBeImplicitMember;
2201     if (!IsAddressOfOperand)
2202       MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2203     else if (!SS.isEmpty())
2204       MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2205     else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
2206       MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2207     else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
2208       MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2209     else
2210       MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2211                               isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2212                               isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
2213 
2214     if (MightBeImplicitMember)
2215       return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
2216                                              R, TemplateArgs);
2217   }
2218 
2219   if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) {
2220 
2221     // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it
2222     // in BuildTemplateIdExpr().
2223     // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration.
2224     if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId &&
2225         Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) {
2226       assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() &&
2227              "There should only be one declaration found.");
2228     }
2229 
2230     return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs);
2231   }
2232 
2233   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
2234 }
2235 
2236 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
2237 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
2238 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
2239 /// this path.
2240 ExprResult
2241 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2242                                         const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2243                                         bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2244                                         TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) {
2245   DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2246   if (!DC)
2247     return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2248                                      NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2249 
2250   if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2251     return ExprError();
2252 
2253   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
2254   LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
2255 
2256   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2257     return ExprError();
2258 
2259   if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2260     return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2261                                      NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2262 
2263   if (R.empty()) {
2264     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2265       << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
2266     return ExprError();
2267   }
2268 
2269   if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) {
2270     // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in
2271     // a dependent context.  If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to
2272     // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode.
2273     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
2274     if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
2275       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
2276     SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc();
2277     auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID);
2278     D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString()
2279       << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc());
2280 
2281     // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE
2282     // context.
2283     if (!RecoveryTSI)
2284       return ExprError();
2285 
2286     // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover.
2287     D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename ");
2288 
2289     // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type.
2290     QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
2291     TypeLocBuilder TLB;
2292     TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc());
2293 
2294     QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty);
2295     ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET);
2296     QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
2297     QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
2298 
2299     *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET);
2300 
2301     return ExprEmpty();
2302   }
2303 
2304   // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually
2305   // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in
2306   // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming
2307   // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11.
2308   if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand)
2309     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS,
2310                                            /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2311                                            R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2312 
2313   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false);
2314 }
2315 
2316 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
2317 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method.  Perform some
2318 /// additional lookup.
2319 ///
2320 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
2321 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
2322 ///
2323 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
2324 ExprResult
2325 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
2326                          IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2327   SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
2328   ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
2329 
2330   // Check for error condition which is already reported.
2331   if (!CurMethod)
2332     return ExprError();
2333 
2334   // There are two cases to handle here.  1) scoped lookup could have failed,
2335   // in which case we should look for an ivar.  2) scoped lookup could have
2336   // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
2337   // a global variable).  In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
2338   // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
2339 
2340   // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
2341   // ivars.  But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
2342   // ivar, that's an error.
2343   bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
2344 
2345   bool LookForIvars;
2346   if (Lookup.empty())
2347     LookForIvars = true;
2348   else if (IsClassMethod)
2349     LookForIvars = false;
2350   else
2351     LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2352                     Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
2353   ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
2354   if (LookForIvars) {
2355     IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
2356     ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2357     ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr;
2358     if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) {
2359       // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
2360       if (IsClassMethod)
2361         return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2362                          << IV->getDeclName());
2363 
2364       // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
2365       // error node.  The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
2366       if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
2367         return ExprError();
2368 
2369       // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
2370       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
2371         return ExprError();
2372 
2373       // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
2374       if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
2375           !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) &&
2376           !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport)
2377         Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2378 
2379       // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
2380       // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
2381       IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
2382       UnqualifiedId SelfName;
2383       SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
2384       SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam);
2385       CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
2386       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
2387       ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc,
2388                                               SelfName, false, false);
2389       if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2390         return ExprError();
2391 
2392       SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get());
2393       if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2394         return ExprError();
2395 
2396       MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true);
2397 
2398       ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily();
2399       if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize &&
2400           !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV))
2401         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2402 
2403       ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context)
2404           ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc, IV->getLocation(),
2405                           SelfExpr.get(), true, true);
2406 
2407       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2408         if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) {
2409           if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc))
2410             recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result);
2411         }
2412         if (CurContext->isClosure())
2413           Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
2414             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->");
2415       }
2416 
2417       return Result;
2418     }
2419   } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
2420     // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
2421     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) {
2422       ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2423       if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
2424         if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
2425             declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared))
2426           Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
2427       }
2428     }
2429   } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2430              Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) {
2431     // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error.
2432     if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl()))
2433       return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2434                        << IV->getDeclName());
2435   }
2436 
2437   if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2438     // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
2439     if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
2440       if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2441             Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
2442         NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
2443                                            S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
2444                                            Lookup.getNameLoc());
2445         if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
2446       }
2447     }
2448   }
2449   // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
2450   return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr);
2451 }
2452 
2453 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
2454 ///
2455 /// Logically this happens in three phases:
2456 ///
2457 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
2458 ///   The naming class is the class into which we were looking
2459 ///   when we found the member;  it's the qualifier type if a
2460 ///   qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
2461 ///
2462 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
2463 ///   If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
2464 ///   a using declaration, this is that class;  otherwise it's
2465 ///   the class declaring the member.
2466 ///
2467 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
2468 ///   declaring class of the member.  This conversion does not
2469 ///   obey access control.
2470 ExprResult
2471 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
2472                                     NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
2473                                     NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
2474                                     NamedDecl *Member) {
2475   CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
2476   if (!RD)
2477     return From;
2478 
2479   QualType DestRecordType;
2480   QualType DestType;
2481   QualType FromRecordType;
2482   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2483   bool PointerConversions = false;
2484   if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
2485     DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
2486 
2487     if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2488       DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
2489       FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2490       PointerConversions = true;
2491     } else {
2492       DestType = DestRecordType;
2493       FromRecordType = FromType;
2494     }
2495   } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
2496     if (Method->isStatic())
2497       return From;
2498 
2499     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
2500     DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
2501 
2502     if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2503       FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2504       PointerConversions = true;
2505     } else {
2506       FromRecordType = FromType;
2507       DestType = DestRecordType;
2508     }
2509   } else {
2510     // No conversion necessary.
2511     return From;
2512   }
2513 
2514   if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
2515     return From;
2516 
2517   // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
2518   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2519     return From;
2520 
2521   SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
2522   SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
2523 
2524   ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
2525 
2526   // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
2527   //   [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
2528   //   class name.
2529   //
2530   // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
2531   // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
2532   // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
2533   // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
2534   //
2535   //   class Base { public: int x; };
2536   //   class Derived1 : public Base { };
2537   //   class Derived2 : public Base { };
2538   //   class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
2539   //
2540   //   void VeryDerived::f() {
2541   //     x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
2542   //     Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
2543   //   }
2544   if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) {
2545     QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
2546     assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
2547 
2548     QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
2549 
2550     // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
2551     // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
2552     // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
2553     if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
2554       CXXCastPath BasePath;
2555       if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
2556                                        FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2557         return ExprError();
2558 
2559       if (PointerConversions)
2560         QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
2561       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2562                                VK, &BasePath).get();
2563 
2564       FromType = QType;
2565       FromRecordType = QRecordType;
2566 
2567       // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
2568       // we're done.
2569       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2570         return From;
2571     }
2572   }
2573 
2574   bool IgnoreAccess = false;
2575 
2576   // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
2577   // down to the using declaration's type.
2578   //
2579   // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
2580   // class ever has member declarations.
2581   if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
2582     assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
2583     QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
2584                            cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
2585 
2586     // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
2587     // conversion is non-trivial.
2588     if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
2589       assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
2590       CXXCastPath BasePath;
2591       if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
2592                                        FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2593         return ExprError();
2594 
2595       QualType UType = URecordType;
2596       if (PointerConversions)
2597         UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
2598       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2599                                VK, &BasePath).get();
2600       FromType = UType;
2601       FromRecordType = URecordType;
2602     }
2603 
2604     // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
2605     // declaring class to the true declaring class.
2606     IgnoreAccess = true;
2607   }
2608 
2609   CXXCastPath BasePath;
2610   if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
2611                                    FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
2612                                    IgnoreAccess))
2613     return ExprError();
2614 
2615   return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2616                            VK, &BasePath);
2617 }
2618 
2619 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2620                                       const LookupResult &R,
2621                                       bool HasTrailingLParen) {
2622   // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
2623   if (!HasTrailingLParen)
2624     return false;
2625 
2626   // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
2627   if (SS.isSet())
2628     return false;
2629 
2630   // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
2631   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2632     return false;
2633 
2634   // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
2635   // normal lookup:
2636   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
2637     NamedDecl *D = *I;
2638 
2639     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2640     //     -- a declaration of a class member
2641     // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
2642     // original decl.
2643     if (D->isCXXClassMember())
2644       return false;
2645 
2646     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2647     //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2648     //        using-declaration
2649     // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2650     // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2651     // turn off ADL anyway).
2652     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2653       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2654     else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2655       return false;
2656 
2657     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2658     //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2659     //        template
2660     // And also for builtin functions.
2661     if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2662       FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2663 
2664       // But also builtin functions.
2665       if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2666         return false;
2667     } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2668       return false;
2669   }
2670 
2671   return true;
2672 }
2673 
2674 
2675 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2676 /// as an expression.  This is only actually called for lookups that
2677 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2678 /// will in fact be used.
2679 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2680   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
2681     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2682     return true;
2683   }
2684 
2685   if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2686     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2687     return true;
2688   }
2689 
2690   if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2691     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2692     return true;
2693   }
2694 
2695   return false;
2696 }
2697 
2698 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2699                                           LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL,
2700                                           bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2701   // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2702   // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
2703   if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
2704     return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(),
2705                                     R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr,
2706                                     AcceptInvalidDecl);
2707 
2708   // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2709   // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2710   // functions and function templates.
2711   if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2712       CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
2713     return ExprError();
2714 
2715   // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression.  Suppress
2716   // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2717   // we've picked a target.
2718   R.suppressDiagnostics();
2719 
2720   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
2721     = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
2722                                    SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
2723                                    R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2724                                    NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2725                                    R.begin(), R.end());
2726 
2727   return ULE;
2728 }
2729 
2730 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
2731 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
2732     const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
2733     NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2734     bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2735   assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
2736   assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2737          "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
2738 
2739   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2740   if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2741     return ExprError();
2742 
2743   if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2744     // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2745     // a template argument list.
2746     Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0)
2747                                            << Template << SS.getRange();
2748     Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2749     return ExprError();
2750   }
2751 
2752   // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2753   ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2754   if (!VD) {
2755     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
2756       << D << SS.getRange();
2757     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2758     return ExprError();
2759   }
2760 
2761   // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2762   // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2763   // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2764   // that overload resolution actually selects.
2765   if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
2766     return ExprError();
2767 
2768   // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2769   if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl)
2770     return ExprError();
2771 
2772   // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions.  If we got here,
2773   // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
2774   // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
2775   if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
2776     if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember())
2777       return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
2778                                                       indirectField);
2779 
2780   {
2781     QualType type = VD->getType();
2782     ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue;
2783 
2784     switch (D->getKind()) {
2785     // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
2786 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
2787 #define VALUE(type, base)
2788 #define DECL(type, base) \
2789     case Decl::type:
2790 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
2791       llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
2792 
2793     // These shouldn't make it here.
2794     case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
2795     case Decl::ObjCIvar:
2796       llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
2797 
2798     // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
2799     // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
2800     case Decl::EnumConstant:
2801     case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
2802       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2803       break;
2804 
2805     // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
2806     // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
2807     // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
2808     // exist in the high-level semantics.
2809     case Decl::Field:
2810     case Decl::IndirectField:
2811       assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2812              "building reference to field in C?");
2813 
2814       // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
2815       // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
2816       type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2817       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2818       break;
2819 
2820     // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
2821     // depending on the type.
2822     case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
2823       if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
2824         type = reftype->getPointeeType();
2825         valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
2826         break;
2827       }
2828 
2829       // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
2830       // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
2831       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2832       type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
2833       break;
2834     }
2835 
2836     case Decl::Var:
2837     case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
2838     case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
2839       // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
2840       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2841           !type.hasQualifiers() &&
2842           type->isVoidType()) {
2843         valueKind = VK_RValue;
2844         break;
2845       }
2846       // fallthrough
2847 
2848     case Decl::ImplicitParam:
2849     case Decl::ParmVar: {
2850       // These are always l-values.
2851       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2852       type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2853 
2854       // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in
2855       // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually
2856       // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no.
2857       if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) {
2858         QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc);
2859         if (!CapturedType.isNull())
2860           type = CapturedType;
2861       }
2862 
2863       break;
2864     }
2865 
2866     case Decl::Function: {
2867       if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) {
2868         if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) {
2869           type = Context.BuiltinFnTy;
2870           valueKind = VK_RValue;
2871           break;
2872         }
2873       }
2874 
2875       const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
2876 
2877       // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
2878       // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2879       if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2880         type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2881         valueKind = VK_RValue;
2882         break;
2883       }
2884 
2885       // Functions are l-values in C++.
2886       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2887         valueKind = VK_LValue;
2888         break;
2889       }
2890 
2891       // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
2892       // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
2893       // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
2894       // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
2895       // type.
2896       if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() &&
2897           isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
2898         type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(),
2899                                               fty->getExtInfo());
2900 
2901       // Functions are r-values in C.
2902       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2903       break;
2904     }
2905 
2906     case Decl::MSProperty:
2907       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2908       break;
2909 
2910     case Decl::CXXMethod:
2911       // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
2912       // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2913       // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
2914       if (const FunctionProtoType *proto
2915             = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
2916         if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2917           type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2918           valueKind = VK_RValue;
2919           break;
2920         }
2921 
2922       // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
2923       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
2924         valueKind = VK_LValue;
2925         break;
2926       }
2927       // fallthrough
2928 
2929     case Decl::CXXConversion:
2930     case Decl::CXXDestructor:
2931     case Decl::CXXConstructor:
2932       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2933       break;
2934     }
2935 
2936     return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD,
2937                             TemplateArgs);
2938   }
2939 }
2940 
2941 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source,
2942                                     SmallString<32> &Target) {
2943   Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1));
2944   char *ResultPtr = &Target[0];
2945   const UTF8 *ErrorPtr;
2946   bool success = ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr);
2947   (void)success;
2948   assert(success);
2949   Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]);
2950 }
2951 
2952 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
2953                                      PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) {
2954   // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function.
2955   Decl *currentDecl = nullptr;
2956   if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock())
2957     currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl;
2958   else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda())
2959     currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator;
2960   else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion())
2961     currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl;
2962   else
2963     currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
2964 
2965   if (!currentDecl) {
2966     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
2967     currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
2968   }
2969 
2970   QualType ResTy;
2971   StringLiteral *SL = nullptr;
2972   if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext())
2973     ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2974   else {
2975     // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of
2976     // the string.
2977     auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl);
2978     unsigned Length = Str.length();
2979 
2980     llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
2981     if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) {
2982       ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst();
2983       SmallString<32> RawChars;
2984       ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(),
2985                               Str, RawChars);
2986       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
2987                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
2988       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide,
2989                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
2990     } else {
2991       ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
2992       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
2993                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
2994       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii,
2995                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
2996     }
2997   }
2998 
2999   return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL);
3000 }
3001 
3002 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
3003   PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
3004 
3005   switch (Kind) {
3006   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!");
3007   case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
3008   case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
3009   case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS]
3010   case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS]
3011   case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break;
3012   case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
3013   }
3014 
3015   return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT);
3016 }
3017 
3018 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3019   SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
3020   bool Invalid = false;
3021   StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
3022   if (Invalid)
3023     return ExprError();
3024 
3025   CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
3026                             PP, Tok.getKind());
3027   if (Literal.hadError())
3028     return ExprError();
3029 
3030   QualType Ty;
3031   if (Literal.isWide())
3032     Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++.
3033   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3034     Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11.
3035   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3036     Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11.
3037   else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar())
3038     Ty = Context.IntTy;   // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
3039   else
3040     Ty = Context.CharTy;  // 'x' -> char in C++
3041 
3042   CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii;
3043   if (Literal.isWide())
3044     Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide;
3045   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3046     Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16;
3047   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3048     Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32;
3049 
3050   Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
3051                                              Tok.getLocation());
3052 
3053   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
3054     return Lit;
3055 
3056   // We're building a user-defined literal.
3057   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3058   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3059     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3060 
3061   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3062   if (!UDLScope)
3063     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl));
3064 
3065   // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
3066   //   operator "" X (ch)
3067   return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc,
3068                                         Lit, Tok.getLocation());
3069 }
3070 
3071 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) {
3072   unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3073   return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val),
3074                                 Context.IntTy, Loc);
3075 }
3076 
3077 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal,
3078                                   QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) {
3079   const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
3080 
3081   using llvm::APFloat;
3082   APFloat Val(Format);
3083 
3084   APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
3085 
3086   // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
3087   // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
3088   if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
3089       ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
3090     unsigned diagnostic;
3091     SmallString<20> buffer;
3092     if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
3093       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
3094       APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
3095     } else {
3096       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
3097       APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
3098     }
3099 
3100     S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
3101       << Ty
3102       << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
3103   }
3104 
3105   bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
3106   return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc);
3107 }
3108 
3109 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
3110   assert(E && "Invalid expression");
3111 
3112   if (E->isValueDependent())
3113     return false;
3114 
3115   QualType QT = E->getType();
3116   if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) {
3117     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT;
3118     return true;
3119   }
3120 
3121   llvm::APSInt ValueAPS;
3122   ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS);
3123 
3124   if (R.isInvalid())
3125     return true;
3126 
3127   bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive();
3128   if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) {
3129     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value)
3130         << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive;
3131     return true;
3132   }
3133 
3134   return false;
3135 }
3136 
3137 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3138   // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common).  A single digit
3139   // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix.
3140   if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
3141     const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
3142     return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0');
3143   }
3144 
3145   SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer;
3146   // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character.  Add padding to
3147   // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer.  If getSpelling()
3148   // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at
3149   // the EOF, so it is also safe.
3150   SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1);
3151 
3152   // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
3153   bool Invalid = false;
3154   StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid);
3155   if (Invalid)
3156     return ExprError();
3157 
3158   NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP);
3159   if (Literal.hadError)
3160     return ExprError();
3161 
3162   if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) {
3163     // We're building a user-defined literal.
3164     IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3165     SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3166       getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3167 
3168     // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3169     if (!UDLScope)
3170       return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl));
3171 
3172     QualType CookedTy;
3173     if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3174       // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3175       // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3176       //   operator "" X (f L)
3177       CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3178     } else {
3179       // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3180       // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3181       //   operator "" X (n ULL)
3182       CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3183     }
3184 
3185     DeclarationName OpName =
3186       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
3187     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
3188     OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
3189 
3190     SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation();
3191 
3192     // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw
3193     // literal or a cooked one.
3194     LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
3195     switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy,
3196                                   /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true,
3197                                   /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) {
3198     case LOLR_Error:
3199       return ExprError();
3200 
3201     case LOLR_Cooked: {
3202       Expr *Lit;
3203       if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3204         Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation());
3205       } else {
3206         llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0);
3207         if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal))
3208           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3209               << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3210         Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy,
3211                                      Tok.getLocation());
3212       }
3213       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3214     }
3215 
3216     case LOLR_Raw: {
3217       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the
3218       // literal is treated as a call of the form
3219       //   operator "" X ("n")
3220       unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset();
3221       QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(
3222           Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1),
3223           ArrayType::Normal, 0);
3224       Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(
3225           Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii,
3226           /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1);
3227       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3228     }
3229 
3230     case LOLR_Template: {
3231       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator
3232       // template), L is treated as a call fo the form
3233       //   operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>()
3234       // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck.
3235       TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
3236       unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy);
3237       bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
3238       llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
3239       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) {
3240         Value = TokSpelling[I];
3241         TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy);
3242         TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
3243         ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
3244       }
3245       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc,
3246                                       &ExplicitArgs);
3247     }
3248     case LOLR_StringTemplate:
3249       llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
3250     }
3251   }
3252 
3253   Expr *Res;
3254 
3255   if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3256     QualType Ty;
3257     if (Literal.isFloat)
3258       Ty = Context.FloatTy;
3259     else if (!Literal.isLong)
3260       Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
3261     else
3262       Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3263 
3264     Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3265 
3266     if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
3267       if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
3268         Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3269       } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
3270                  !((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) ||
3271                    getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64)) {
3272         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64);
3273         Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3274       }
3275     }
3276   } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
3277     return ExprError();
3278   } else {
3279     QualType Ty;
3280 
3281     // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature.
3282     if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) {
3283       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
3284         Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
3285              getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
3286              diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong);
3287       else
3288         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong);
3289     }
3290 
3291     // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
3292     unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth();
3293     // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which
3294     // may be wider than [u]intmax_t.
3295     // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the
3296     //        i128 suffix.
3297     if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 &&
3298         Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
3299       MaxWidth = 128;
3300     llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0);
3301 
3302     if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
3303       // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull.
3304       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3305           << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3306       Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3307       assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
3308              "long long is not intmax_t?");
3309     } else {
3310       // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
3311       // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
3312 
3313       // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
3314       // be an unsigned int.
3315       bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
3316 
3317       // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
3318       unsigned Width = 0;
3319 
3320       // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized.
3321       if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
3322         if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) {
3323           // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull.
3324           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported);
3325           Width = MaxWidth;
3326           Ty = Context.getIntMaxType();
3327         } else {
3328           Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
3329           Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width,
3330                                              /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned);
3331         }
3332       }
3333 
3334       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3335         // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
3336         unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3337 
3338         // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
3339         if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
3340           // Does it fit in a signed int?
3341           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
3342             Ty = Context.IntTy;
3343           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3344             Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
3345           Width = IntSize;
3346         }
3347       }
3348 
3349       // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
3350       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3351         unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
3352 
3353         // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
3354         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
3355           // Does it fit in a signed long?
3356           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
3357             Ty = Context.LongTy;
3358           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3359             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
3360           Width = LongSize;
3361         }
3362       }
3363 
3364       // Check long long if needed.
3365       if (Ty.isNull()) {
3366         unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3367 
3368         // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
3369         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
3370           // Does it fit in a signed long long?
3371           // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
3372           // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
3373           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
3374               (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong)))
3375             Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
3376           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3377             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3378           Width = LongLongSize;
3379         }
3380       }
3381 
3382       // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
3383       // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
3384       if (Ty.isNull()) {
3385         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed);
3386         Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3387         Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3388       }
3389 
3390       if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
3391         ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
3392     }
3393     Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3394   }
3395 
3396   // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
3397   if (Literal.isImaginary)
3398     Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
3399                                         Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
3400 
3401   return Res;
3402 }
3403 
3404 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
3405   assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
3406   return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E);
3407 }
3408 
3409 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3410                                          SourceLocation Loc,
3411                                          SourceRange ArgRange) {
3412   // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
3413   // scalar or vector data type argument..."
3414   // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
3415   // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
3416   if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
3417     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
3418       << T << ArgRange;
3419     return true;
3420   }
3421 
3422   assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
3423          "Scalar types should always be complete");
3424   return false;
3425 }
3426 
3427 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3428                                            SourceLocation Loc,
3429                                            SourceRange ArgRange,
3430                                            UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3431   // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++.
3432   if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus)
3433     return true;
3434 
3435   // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
3436   if (T->isFunctionType() &&
3437       (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) {
3438     // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
3439     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3440       << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3441     return false;
3442   }
3443 
3444   // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where
3445   // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k)
3446   if (T->isVoidType()) {
3447     unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type
3448                                         : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type;
3449     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3450     return false;
3451   }
3452 
3453   return true;
3454 }
3455 
3456 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
3457                                              SourceLocation Loc,
3458                                              SourceRange ArgRange,
3459                                              UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3460   // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the
3461   // runtime doesn't allow it.
3462   if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
3463     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
3464       << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
3465       << ArgRange;
3466     return true;
3467   }
3468 
3469   return false;
3470 }
3471 
3472 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed
3473 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is.
3474 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
3475                                      Expr *E) {
3476   // Don't warn if the operation changed the type.
3477   if (T != E->getType())
3478     return;
3479 
3480   // Now look for array decays.
3481   ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
3482   if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay)
3483     return;
3484 
3485   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange()
3486                                              << ICE->getType()
3487                                              << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType();
3488 }
3489 
3490 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression
3491 /// and type traits.
3492 ///
3493 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
3494 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify
3495 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template
3496 /// instantiation, etc.
3497 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
3498                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3499   QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
3500   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3501 
3502   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3503     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3504                                         E->getSourceRange());
3505 
3506   // Whitelist some types as extensions
3507   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3508                                       E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3509     return false;
3510 
3511   // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of
3512   // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to
3513   // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown
3514   // bound).
3515   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3516     if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(),
3517                             Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()),
3518                             diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind,
3519                             E->getSourceRange()))
3520       return true;
3521   } else {
3522     if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3523                                 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange()))
3524       return true;
3525   }
3526 
3527   // Completing the expression's type may have changed it.
3528   ExprTy = E->getType();
3529   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3530 
3531   if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) {
3532     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3533       << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange();
3534     return true;
3535   }
3536 
3537   // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context,
3538   // so side effects could result in unintended consequences.
3539   if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) &&
3540       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
3541     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
3542 
3543   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3544                                        E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3545     return true;
3546 
3547   if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
3548     if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3549       if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
3550         QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
3551         QualType Type = PVD->getType();
3552         if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
3553           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
3554             << Type << OType;
3555           Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
3556         }
3557       }
3558     }
3559 
3560     // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array
3561     // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most
3562     // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x".
3563     if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3564       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3565                                BO->getLHS());
3566       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3567                                BO->getRHS());
3568     }
3569   }
3570 
3571   return false;
3572 }
3573 
3574 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
3575 /// traits.
3576 ///
3577 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints
3578 /// on those operands.
3579 ///
3580 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
3581 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
3582 ///   Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
3583 ///
3584 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
3585 ///   The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
3586 ///   standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
3587 ///
3588 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
3589 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
3590                                             SourceLocation OpLoc,
3591                                             SourceRange ExprRange,
3592                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3593   if (ExprType->isDependentType())
3594     return false;
3595 
3596   // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2:
3597   //     When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result
3598   //     is the size of the referenced type.
3599   // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3600   //     When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result
3601   //     shall be the alignment of the referenced type.
3602   if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3603     ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3604 
3605   // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3606   //   When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result
3607   //   is the alignment of the element type.
3608   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf)
3609     ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType);
3610 
3611   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3612     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
3613 
3614   // Whitelist some types as extensions
3615   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3616                                       ExprKind))
3617     return false;
3618 
3619   if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType,
3620                           diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3621                           ExprKind, ExprRange))
3622     return true;
3623 
3624   if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) {
3625     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3626       << ExprKind << ExprRange;
3627     return true;
3628   }
3629 
3630   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3631                                        ExprKind))
3632     return true;
3633 
3634   return false;
3635 }
3636 
3637 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
3638   E = E->IgnoreParens();
3639 
3640   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3641   if (E->isTypeDependent())
3642     return false;
3643 
3644   if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) {
3645     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield)
3646        << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
3647     return true;
3648   }
3649 
3650   ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
3651   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
3652     D = DRE->getDecl();
3653   } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
3654     D = ME->getMemberDecl();
3655   }
3656 
3657   // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a
3658   // complete definition so that we can compute the layout.
3659   //
3660   // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member
3661   // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression
3662   // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member
3663   // in a trailing-return-type.
3664   //
3665   // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC
3666   // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the
3667   // nonsensical answer 0.
3668   //
3669   // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just
3670   // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing
3671   // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of
3672   // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal
3673   // use-case.
3674   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) {
3675     // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a
3676     // definition if we can find a member of it.
3677     if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) {
3678       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type)
3679         << E->getSourceRange();
3680       return true;
3681     }
3682 
3683     // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have
3684     // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a
3685     // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to
3686     // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial.
3687     if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
3688       return false;
3689   }
3690 
3691   return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf);
3692 }
3693 
3694 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
3695   E = E->IgnoreParens();
3696 
3697   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3698   if (E->isTypeDependent())
3699     return false;
3700 
3701   return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
3702 }
3703 
3704 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
3705 ExprResult
3706 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3707                                      SourceLocation OpLoc,
3708                                      UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
3709                                      SourceRange R) {
3710   if (!TInfo)
3711     return ExprError();
3712 
3713   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
3714 
3715   if (!T->isDependentType() &&
3716       CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind))
3717     return ExprError();
3718 
3719   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3720   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3721       ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd());
3722 }
3723 
3724 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
3725 /// operand.
3726 ExprResult
3727 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3728                                      UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3729   ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
3730   if (PE.isInvalid())
3731     return ExprError();
3732 
3733   E = PE.get();
3734 
3735   // Verify that the operand is valid.
3736   bool isInvalid = false;
3737   if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
3738     // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
3739   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3740     isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E);
3741   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
3742     isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
3743   } else if (E->refersToBitField()) {  // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
3744     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
3745     isInvalid = true;
3746   } else {
3747     isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf);
3748   }
3749 
3750   if (isInvalid)
3751     return ExprError();
3752 
3753   if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) {
3754     PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
3755     if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3756     E = PE.get();
3757   }
3758 
3759   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3760   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3761       ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
3762 }
3763 
3764 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
3765 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
3766 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
3767 ExprResult
3768 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
3769                                     UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
3770                                     void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
3771   // If error parsing type, ignore.
3772   if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError();
3773 
3774   if (IsType) {
3775     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3776     (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
3777     return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
3778   }
3779 
3780   Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
3781   ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
3782   return Result;
3783 }
3784 
3785 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
3786                                      bool IsReal) {
3787   if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
3788     return S.Context.DependentTy;
3789 
3790   // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
3791   if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
3792     V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get());
3793     if (V.isInvalid())
3794       return QualType();
3795   }
3796 
3797   // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
3798   if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
3799     return CT->getElementType();
3800 
3801   // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
3802   if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
3803     return V.get()->getType();
3804 
3805   // Test for placeholders.
3806   ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
3807   if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
3808   if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
3809     V = PR;
3810     return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
3811   }
3812 
3813   // Reject anything else.
3814   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
3815     << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
3816   return QualType();
3817 }
3818 
3819 
3820 
3821 ExprResult
3822 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3823                           tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
3824   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
3825   switch (Kind) {
3826   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
3827   case tok::plusplus:   Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
3828   case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
3829   }
3830 
3831   // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3832   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input);
3833   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3834   Input = Result.get();
3835 
3836   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
3837 }
3838 
3839 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal.
3840 ///
3841 /// \return true on error
3842 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S,
3843                                          SourceLocation opLoc,
3844                                          Expr *op) {
3845   assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType());
3846   if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() &&
3847       !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime)
3848     return false;
3849 
3850   S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
3851     << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3852     << op->getSourceRange();
3853   return true;
3854 }
3855 
3856 ExprResult
3857 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc,
3858                               Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) {
3859   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3860   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) {
3861     ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base);
3862     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3863     base = result.get();
3864   }
3865 
3866   // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index
3867   // expressions.  We can't handle overloads here because the other
3868   // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload
3869   // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack
3870   // at the overload.
3871   if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3872     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base);
3873     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3874     base = result.get();
3875   }
3876   if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3877     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx);
3878     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3879     idx = result.get();
3880   }
3881 
3882   // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
3883   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3884       (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) {
3885     return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy,
3886                                             VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
3887   }
3888 
3889   // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record
3890   // type.  The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*,
3891   // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion
3892   // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution
3893   // to do if there aren't any record types involved.
3894   //
3895   // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied
3896   // to overload resolution and so should not take this path.
3897   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3898       (base->getType()->isRecordType() ||
3899        (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3900         idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) {
3901     return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx);
3902   }
3903 
3904   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc);
3905 }
3906 
3907 ExprResult
3908 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
3909                                       Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
3910   Expr *LHSExp = Base;
3911   Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
3912 
3913   // Perform default conversions.
3914   if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) {
3915     ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
3916     if (Result.isInvalid())
3917       return ExprError();
3918     LHSExp = Result.get();
3919   }
3920   ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
3921   if (Result.isInvalid())
3922     return ExprError();
3923   RHSExp = Result.get();
3924 
3925   QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
3926   ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
3927   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
3928 
3929   // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
3930   // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
3931   // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
3932   // and index from the expression types.
3933   Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
3934   QualType ResultType;
3935   if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
3936     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3937     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3938     ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
3939   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3940     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3941     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3942     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
3943   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
3944                LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3945     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3946     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3947 
3948     // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript
3949     // expression.
3950     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic())
3951       return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr,
3952                                           nullptr);
3953 
3954     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
3955   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3956      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
3957     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
3958     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
3959     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
3960   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
3961                RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3962      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
3963     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
3964     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
3965     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
3966     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) {
3967       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
3968         << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3969       return ExprError();
3970     }
3971   } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
3972     BaseExpr = LHSExp;    // vectors: V[123]
3973     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3974     VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
3975     if (VK != VK_RValue)
3976       OK = OK_VectorComponent;
3977 
3978     // FIXME: need to deal with const...
3979     ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
3980   } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
3981     // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
3982     // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
3983     // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
3984     // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays.  Warn, then
3985     // force the promotion here.
3986     Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
3987         LHSExp->getSourceRange();
3988     LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
3989                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
3990     LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
3991 
3992     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3993     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3994     ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3995   } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
3996     // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
3997     Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
3998         RHSExp->getSourceRange();
3999     RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
4000                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
4001     RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
4002 
4003     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4004     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4005     ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4006   } else {
4007     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
4008        << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
4009   }
4010   // C99 6.5.2.1p1
4011   if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4012     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
4013                      << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
4014 
4015   if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
4016        IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
4017          && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4018     Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
4019 
4020   // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
4021   // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
4022   // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
4023   // incomplete types are not object types.
4024   if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
4025     Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
4026       << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4027     return ExprError();
4028   }
4029 
4030   if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4031     // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
4032     Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
4033       << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4034 
4035     // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
4036     // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
4037     if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
4038   } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
4039       RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
4040                           diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr))
4041     return ExprError();
4042 
4043   assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
4044          !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
4045 
4046   return new (Context)
4047       ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc);
4048 }
4049 
4050 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4051                                         FunctionDecl *FD,
4052                                         ParmVarDecl *Param) {
4053   if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
4054     Diag(CallLoc,
4055          diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
4056       FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
4057     Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
4058          diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
4059     return ExprError();
4060   }
4061 
4062   if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
4063     Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
4064 
4065     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated,
4066                                                  Param);
4067 
4068     // Instantiate the expression.
4069     MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList
4070       = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
4071 
4072     InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
4073                                MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost());
4074     if (Inst.isInvalid())
4075       return ExprError();
4076 
4077     ExprResult Result;
4078     {
4079       // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
4080       //   The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
4081       //   the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
4082       //   default argument expression appears.
4083       ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
4084       LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this);
4085       Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList);
4086     }
4087     if (Result.isInvalid())
4088       return ExprError();
4089 
4090     // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
4091     InitializedEntity Entity
4092       = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
4093     InitializationKind Kind
4094       = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
4095              /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart());
4096     Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4097 
4098     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4099     Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4100     if (Result.isInvalid())
4101       return ExprError();
4102 
4103     Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4104     CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart());
4105     // Build the default argument expression.
4106     return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4107   }
4108 
4109   // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
4110   // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
4111   // be properly destroyed.
4112   // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
4113   // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
4114   // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because
4115   // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything.
4116   if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) {
4117     // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are
4118     // any explicit objects.
4119     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
4120 
4121     // Append all the objects to the cleanup list.  Right now, this
4122     // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument
4123     // expressions should never be able to capture anything.
4124     assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() &&
4125            "default argument expression has capturing blocks?");
4126   }
4127 
4128   // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
4129   // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
4130   // as being "referenced".
4131   MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(),
4132                                    /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true);
4133   return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param);
4134 }
4135 
4136 
4137 Sema::VariadicCallType
4138 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4139                           Expr *Fn) {
4140   if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) {
4141     if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl))
4142       return VariadicConstructor;
4143     else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
4144       return VariadicBlock;
4145     else if (FDecl) {
4146       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4147         if (Method->isInstance())
4148           return VariadicMethod;
4149     } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy)
4150       return VariadicMethod;
4151     return VariadicFunction;
4152   }
4153   return VariadicDoesNotApply;
4154 }
4155 
4156 namespace {
4157 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC {
4158 public:
4159   FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName,
4160                   unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME)
4161       : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME),
4162         FunctionName(FuncName) {}
4163 
4164   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
4165     if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() ||
4166         candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) {
4167       return false;
4168     }
4169 
4170     return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate);
4171   }
4172 
4173 private:
4174   const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName;
4175 };
4176 }
4177 
4178 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn,
4179                                                FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4180                                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
4181   MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn);
4182   DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName();
4183   SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart();
4184 
4185   if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo(
4186           DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
4187           S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr,
4188           llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
4189                                              Args.size(), ME),
4190           Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
4191     if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) {
4192       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
4193         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
4194         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4195         for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
4196                                            CDEnd = Corrected.end();
4197              CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
4198           if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
4199             S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args,
4200                                    OCS);
4201         }
4202         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) {
4203         case OR_Success:
4204           ND = Best->Function;
4205           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
4206           break;
4207         default:
4208           break;
4209         }
4210       }
4211       if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) {
4212         return Corrected;
4213       }
4214     }
4215   }
4216   return TypoCorrection();
4217 }
4218 
4219 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
4220 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
4221 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
4222 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
4223 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
4224 /// true if the call is ill-formed.
4225 bool
4226 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
4227                               FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4228                               const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4229                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4230                               SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4231                               bool IsExecConfig) {
4232   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4233   // We don't need to do this in the
4234   if (FDecl)
4235     if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
4236       if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
4237         return false;
4238 
4239   // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
4240   // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
4241   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4242   bool Invalid = false;
4243   unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams;
4244   unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
4245                        ? 1 /* block */
4246                        : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
4247                                        : 0 /* function */);
4248 
4249   // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
4250   // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
4251   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
4252     if (Args.size() < MinArgs) {
4253       TypoCorrection TC;
4254       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4255         unsigned diag_id =
4256             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4257                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest
4258                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest;
4259         diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs
4260                                         << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4261                                         << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4262       } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4263         Diag(RParenLoc,
4264              MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4265                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one
4266                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one)
4267             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange();
4268       else
4269         Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4270                             ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
4271                             : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
4272             << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4273             << Fn->getSourceRange();
4274 
4275       // Emit the location of the prototype.
4276       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4277         Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4278           << FDecl;
4279 
4280       return true;
4281     }
4282     Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4283   }
4284 
4285   // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
4286   // them.
4287   if (Args.size() > NumParams) {
4288     if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
4289       TypoCorrection TC;
4290       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4291         unsigned diag_id =
4292             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4293                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest
4294                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest;
4295         diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams
4296                                         << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4297                                         << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4298       } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl &&
4299                  FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4300         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4301              MinArgs == NumParams
4302                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one
4303                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one)
4304             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0)
4305             << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange()
4306             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4307                            Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4308       else
4309         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4310              MinArgs == NumParams
4311                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
4312                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
4313             << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4314             << Fn->getSourceRange()
4315             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4316                            Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4317 
4318       // Emit the location of the prototype.
4319       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4320         Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4321           << FDecl;
4322 
4323       // This deletes the extra arguments.
4324       Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4325       return true;
4326     }
4327   }
4328   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
4329   VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn);
4330 
4331   Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl,
4332                                    Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType);
4333   if (Invalid)
4334     return true;
4335   unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
4336   for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
4337     Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
4338 
4339   return false;
4340 }
4341 
4342 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4343                                   const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4344                                   unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4345                                   SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs,
4346                                   VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit,
4347                                   bool IsListInitialization) {
4348   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4349   bool Invalid = false;
4350   unsigned ArgIx = 0;
4351   // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
4352   for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) {
4353     QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i);
4354 
4355     Expr *Arg;
4356     ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr;
4357     if (ArgIx < Args.size()) {
4358       Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
4359 
4360       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
4361                               ProtoArgType,
4362                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
4363         return true;
4364 
4365       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
4366       bool CFAudited = false;
4367       if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy &&
4368           FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4369           (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4370         Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg);
4371       else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
4372                FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4373                (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4374         CFAudited = true;
4375 
4376       InitializedEntity Entity =
4377           Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param,
4378                                                          ProtoArgType)
4379                 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
4380                       Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
4381 
4382       // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API.
4383       if (CFAudited)
4384         Entity.setParameterCFAudited();
4385 
4386       ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(
4387           Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit);
4388       if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4389         return true;
4390 
4391       Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
4392     } else {
4393       assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee");
4394 
4395       ExprResult ArgExpr =
4396         BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
4397       if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
4398         return true;
4399 
4400       Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
4401     }
4402 
4403     // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
4404     // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
4405     // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
4406     CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
4407 
4408     // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7).
4409     CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4410 
4411     AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
4412   }
4413 
4414   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
4415   if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
4416     // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
4417     // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
4418     if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl &&
4419         FDecl->isExternC()) {
4420       for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4421         QualType paramType; // ignored
4422         ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType);
4423         Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
4424         AllArgs.push_back(arg.get());
4425       }
4426 
4427     // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
4428     } else {
4429       for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4430         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType,
4431                                                           FDecl);
4432         Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
4433         AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get());
4434       }
4435     }
4436 
4437     // Check for array bounds violations.
4438     for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
4439       CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]);
4440   }
4441   return Invalid;
4442 }
4443 
4444 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) {
4445   TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
4446   if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>())
4447     TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc();
4448   if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>())
4449     S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array)
4450       << ATL.getLocalSourceRange();
4451 }
4452 
4453 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static
4454 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by
4455 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large.
4456 ///
4457 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the
4458 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the
4459 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of
4460 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression.
4461 void
4462 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4463                                ParmVarDecl *Param,
4464                                const Expr *ArgExpr) {
4465   // Static array parameters are not supported in C++.
4466   if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4467     return;
4468 
4469   QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType();
4470 
4471   const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy);
4472   if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static)
4473     return;
4474 
4475   if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
4476                                      Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) {
4477     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange();
4478     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4479     return;
4480   }
4481 
4482   const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT);
4483   if (!CAT)
4484     return;
4485 
4486   const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT =
4487     Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType());
4488   if (!ArgCAT)
4489     return;
4490 
4491   if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) {
4492     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
4493       << ArgExpr->getSourceRange()
4494       << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue()
4495       << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
4496     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4497   }
4498 }
4499 
4500 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
4501 /// to have a function type.
4502 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
4503 
4504 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out
4505 /// immediately during argument processing?
4506 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) {
4507   // Placeholders are never sugared.
4508   const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type);
4509   if (!placeholder) return false;
4510 
4511   switch (placeholder->getKind()) {
4512   // Ignore all the non-placeholder types.
4513 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID)
4514 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID:
4515 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
4516     return false;
4517 
4518   // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved
4519   // by the call machinery.
4520   case BuiltinType::Overload:
4521     return false;
4522 
4523   // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and
4524   // should be left in place.
4525   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast:
4526     return false;
4527 
4528   // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible.
4529   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
4530     return true;
4531 
4532   // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try
4533   // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types.
4534   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
4535     return true;
4536 
4537   // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported.
4538   case BuiltinType::BoundMember:
4539   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn:
4540     return true;
4541   }
4542   llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind");
4543 }
4544 
4545 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to
4546 /// handle later.
4547 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) {
4548   // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of
4549   // dying at the first failure.
4550   bool hasInvalid = false;
4551   for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) {
4552     if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) {
4553       ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]);
4554       if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true;
4555       else args[i] = result.get();
4556     } else if (hasInvalid) {
4557       (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]);
4558     }
4559   }
4560   return hasInvalid;
4561 }
4562 
4563 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
4564 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
4565 /// locations.
4566 ExprResult
4567 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4568                     MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4569                     Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) {
4570   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
4571   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
4572   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4573   Fn = Result.get();
4574 
4575   if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs))
4576     return ExprError();
4577 
4578   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4579     // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
4580     if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
4581       if (!ArgExprs.empty()) {
4582         // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
4583         Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
4584           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
4585                                     SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(),
4586                                                 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd()));
4587       }
4588 
4589       return new (Context)
4590           CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4591     }
4592     if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) {
4593       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn);
4594       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4595       Fn = result.get();
4596     }
4597 
4598     // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
4599     // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
4600     // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
4601     // Fn.
4602     bool Dependent = false;
4603     if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
4604       Dependent = true;
4605     else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))
4606       Dependent = true;
4607 
4608     if (Dependent) {
4609       if (ExecConfig) {
4610         return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(
4611             Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs,
4612             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4613       } else {
4614         return new (Context) CallExpr(
4615             Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4616       }
4617     }
4618 
4619     // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
4620     if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
4621       return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4622                                           RParenLoc);
4623 
4624     if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4625       ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4626       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4627       Fn = result.get();
4628     }
4629 
4630     if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
4631       return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc);
4632     }
4633   }
4634 
4635   // Check for overloaded calls.  This can happen even in C due to extensions.
4636   if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
4637     OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
4638 
4639     // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved.
4640     if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
4641       OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
4642       if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) {
4643         UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl);
4644         return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4645                                        RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
4646       } else {
4647         return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4648                                          RParenLoc);
4649       }
4650     }
4651   }
4652 
4653   // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
4654   if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4655     ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4656     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4657     Fn = result.get();
4658   }
4659 
4660   Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
4661 
4662   NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr;
4663   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4664     if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4665       NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4666 
4667   if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
4668     NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4669   else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
4670     NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl();
4671 
4672   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) {
4673     if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) {
4674       if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) {
4675         Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
4676              isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ?
4677                  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call :
4678                  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
4679           << FD << FD->getSourceRange();
4680         Diag(FD->getLocation(),
4681              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
4682             << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
4683       }
4684     }
4685   }
4686 
4687   return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
4688                                ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
4689 }
4690 
4691 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments.
4692 ///
4693 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
4694 ///
4695 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4696                                  SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4697                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4698   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
4699   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
4700   QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
4701   QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
4702   if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4703     return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc,
4704                           diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
4705                      << DstTy
4706                      << SrcTy
4707                      << E->getSourceRange());
4708   return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4709 }
4710 
4711 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the
4712 /// provided arguments.
4713 ///
4714 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type )
4715 ///
4716 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4717                                         SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4718                                         SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4719   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4720   GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo);
4721   return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4722 }
4723 
4724 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4725 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy.  The expression should
4726 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4727 /// block-pointer type.
4728 ///
4729 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
4730 ExprResult
4731 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4732                             SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4733                             ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4734                             SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4735                             Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) {
4736   FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4737   unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
4738 
4739   // Promote the function operand.
4740   // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting
4741   // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call.
4742   ExprResult Result;
4743   if (BuiltinID &&
4744       Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) {
4745     Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()),
4746                                CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
4747   } else {
4748     Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn);
4749   }
4750   if (Result.isInvalid())
4751     return ExprError();
4752   Fn = Result.get();
4753 
4754   // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks.  This guarantees cleanup
4755   // of arguments and function on error.
4756   CallExpr *TheCall;
4757   if (Config)
4758     TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn,
4759                                                cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args,
4760                                                Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue,
4761                                                RParenLoc);
4762   else
4763     TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy,
4764                                      VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4765 
4766   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4767   if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID))
4768     return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
4769 
4770  retry:
4771   const FunctionType *FuncT;
4772   if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4773     // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4774     // have type pointer to function".
4775     FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
4776     if (!FuncT)
4777       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4778                          << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4779   } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
4780                Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4781     FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
4782   } else {
4783     // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
4784     if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4785       ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4786       if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4787       Fn = rewrite.get();
4788       TheCall->setCallee(Fn);
4789       goto retry;
4790     }
4791 
4792     return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4793       << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4794   }
4795 
4796   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
4797     if (Config) {
4798       // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
4799       if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4800         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
4801             << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4802 
4803       // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
4804       if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType())
4805         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
4806             << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4807     } else {
4808       // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
4809       if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4810         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
4811             << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4812     }
4813   }
4814 
4815   // Check for a valid return type
4816   if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall,
4817                           FDecl))
4818     return ExprError();
4819 
4820   // We know the result type of the call, set it.
4821   TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
4822   TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType()));
4823 
4824   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT);
4825   if (Proto) {
4826     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc,
4827                                 IsExecConfig))
4828       return ExprError();
4829   } else {
4830     assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
4831 
4832     if (FDecl) {
4833       // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4834       // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4835       const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
4836       if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) {
4837         Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4838        if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size()))
4839           Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4840           << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
4841       }
4842 
4843       // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4844       // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4845       if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4846         Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4847     }
4848 
4849     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
4850     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
4851       Expr *Arg = Args[i];
4852 
4853       if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) {
4854         InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
4855             Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
4856         ExprResult ArgE =
4857             PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg);
4858         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4859           return true;
4860 
4861         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
4862 
4863       } else {
4864         ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
4865 
4866         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4867           return true;
4868 
4869         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
4870       }
4871 
4872       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
4873                               Arg->getType(),
4874                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
4875         return ExprError();
4876 
4877       TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
4878     }
4879   }
4880 
4881   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4882     if (!Method->isStatic())
4883       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
4884         << Fn->getSourceRange());
4885 
4886   // Check for sentinels
4887   if (NDecl)
4888     DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args);
4889 
4890   // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
4891   if (FDecl) {
4892     if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto))
4893       return ExprError();
4894 
4895     if (BuiltinID)
4896       return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
4897   } else if (NDecl) {
4898     if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto))
4899       return ExprError();
4900   } else {
4901     if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto))
4902       return ExprError();
4903   }
4904 
4905   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
4906 }
4907 
4908 ExprResult
4909 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
4910                            SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
4911   assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
4912   // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
4913   //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
4914 
4915   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4916   QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
4917   if (!TInfo)
4918     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
4919 
4920   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
4921 }
4922 
4923 ExprResult
4924 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
4925                                SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
4926   QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
4927 
4928   if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
4929     if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
4930           diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type,
4931           SourceRange(LParenLoc,
4932                       LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4933       return ExprError();
4934     if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
4935       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
4936         << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
4937   } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
4938              RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
4939                diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type,
4940                SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4941     return ExprError();
4942 
4943   InitializedEntity Entity
4944     = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo);
4945   InitializationKind Kind
4946     = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
4947                                            SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
4948                                            /*InitList=*/true);
4949   InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr);
4950   ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr,
4951                                       &literalType);
4952   if (Result.isInvalid())
4953     return ExprError();
4954   LiteralExpr = Result.get();
4955 
4956   bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr;
4957   if (isFileScope &&
4958       !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
4959       !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() &&
4960       !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3
4961     if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType))
4962       return ExprError();
4963   }
4964 
4965   // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
4966   ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue;
4967 
4968   return MaybeBindToTemporary(
4969            new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
4970                                              VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope));
4971 }
4972 
4973 ExprResult
4974 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
4975                     SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
4976   // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders.  Overloads can be
4977   // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't.
4978   for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
4979     if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
4980       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]);
4981 
4982       // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because
4983       // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc.
4984       if (result.isInvalid()) continue;
4985 
4986       InitArgList[I] = result.get();
4987     }
4988   }
4989 
4990   // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
4991   // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
4992 
4993   InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList,
4994                                                RBraceLoc);
4995   E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
4996   return E;
4997 }
4998 
4999 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
5000 static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) {
5001   assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
5002   assert(E.get()->isRValue());
5003 
5004   // Only do this in an r-value context.
5005   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
5006 
5007   E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(),
5008                                CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
5009                                /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue);
5010   S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
5011 }
5012 
5013 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object
5014 /// pointer type.
5015 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) {
5016   QualType type = E.get()->getType();
5017   if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5018     return CK_BitCast;
5019   } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) {
5020     maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E);
5021     return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5022   } else {
5023     assert(type->isPointerType());
5024     return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5025   }
5026 }
5027 
5028 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
5029 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
5030 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
5031   // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
5032   // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
5033   // pointers.  Everything else should be possible.
5034 
5035   QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
5036   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
5037     return CK_NoOp;
5038 
5039   switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5040   case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5041     llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5042 
5043   case Type::STK_CPointer:
5044   case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5045   case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5046     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5047     case Type::STK_CPointer: {
5048       unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5049       unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5050       if (SrcAS != DestAS)
5051         return CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5052       return CK_BitCast;
5053     }
5054     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5055       return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
5056                 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
5057     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5058       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
5059         return CK_BitCast;
5060       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
5061         return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5062       maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src);
5063       return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5064     case Type::STK_Bool:
5065       return CK_PointerToBoolean;
5066     case Type::STK_Integral:
5067       return CK_PointerToIntegral;
5068     case Type::STK_Floating:
5069     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5070     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5071     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5072       llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
5073     }
5074     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5075 
5076   case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
5077   case Type::STK_Integral:
5078     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5079     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5080     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5081     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5082       if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5083                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5084         return CK_NullToPointer;
5085       return CK_IntegralToPointer;
5086     case Type::STK_Bool:
5087       return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
5088     case Type::STK_Integral:
5089       return CK_IntegralCast;
5090     case Type::STK_Floating:
5091       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5092     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5093       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5094                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5095                               CK_IntegralCast);
5096       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5097     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5098       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5099                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5100                               CK_IntegralToFloating);
5101       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5102     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5103       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5104     }
5105     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5106 
5107   case Type::STK_Floating:
5108     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5109     case Type::STK_Floating:
5110       return CK_FloatingCast;
5111     case Type::STK_Bool:
5112       return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
5113     case Type::STK_Integral:
5114       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5115     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5116       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5117                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5118                               CK_FloatingCast);
5119       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5120     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5121       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5122                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5123                               CK_FloatingToIntegral);
5124       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5125     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5126     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5127     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5128       llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
5129     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5130       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5131     }
5132     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5133 
5134   case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5135     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5136     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5137       return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
5138     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5139       return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
5140     case Type::STK_Floating: {
5141       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5142       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5143         return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
5144       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5145       return CK_FloatingCast;
5146     }
5147     case Type::STK_Bool:
5148       return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
5149     case Type::STK_Integral:
5150       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5151                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5152                               CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5153       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5154     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5155     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5156     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5157       llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
5158     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5159       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5160     }
5161     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5162 
5163   case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5164     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5165     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5166       return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
5167     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5168       return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
5169     case Type::STK_Integral: {
5170       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5171       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5172         return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
5173       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5174       return CK_IntegralCast;
5175     }
5176     case Type::STK_Bool:
5177       return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
5178     case Type::STK_Floating:
5179       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5180                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5181                               CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5182       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5183     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5184     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5185     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5186       llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
5187     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5188       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5189     }
5190     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5191   }
5192 
5193   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
5194 }
5195 
5196 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len,
5197                                 QualType &eltType) {
5198   // Vectors are simple.
5199   if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5200     len = vecType->getNumElements();
5201     eltType = vecType->getElementType();
5202     assert(eltType->isScalarType());
5203     return true;
5204   }
5205 
5206   // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if
5207   // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types).
5208   if (!type->isRealType()) return false;
5209 
5210   len = 1;
5211   eltType = type;
5212   return true;
5213 }
5214 
5215 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5216   uint64_t srcLen, destLen;
5217   QualType srcElt, destElt;
5218   if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false;
5219   if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false;
5220 
5221   // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a
5222   // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw
5223   // element size multiplied by the element count.
5224   uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt);
5225   uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt);
5226 
5227   return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize);
5228 }
5229 
5230 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types?
5231 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5232   assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
5233 
5234   if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions)
5235     return false;
5236   return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy);
5237 }
5238 
5239 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
5240                            CastKind &Kind) {
5241   assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
5242 
5243   if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
5244     if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy))
5245       return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5246                   Ty->isVectorType() ?
5247                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
5248                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
5249         << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5250   } else
5251     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5252                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5253       << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5254 
5255   Kind = CK_BitCast;
5256   return false;
5257 }
5258 
5259 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
5260                                     Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
5261   assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
5262 
5263   QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
5264 
5265   // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
5266   // an ExtVectorType.
5267   // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
5268   // (See OpenCL 6.2).
5269   if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
5270     if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy)
5271         || (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5272             (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) {
5273       Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
5274         << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5275       return ExprError();
5276     }
5277     Kind = CK_BitCast;
5278     return CastExpr;
5279   }
5280 
5281   // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type.  The appropriate
5282   // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
5283   // splat from elt type to vector.
5284   if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
5285     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5286                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5287       << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5288 
5289   QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
5290   ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr;
5291   CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
5292   if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
5293     return ExprError();
5294   CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get();
5295 
5296   Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
5297   return CastExpr;
5298 }
5299 
5300 ExprResult
5301 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5302                     Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
5303                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
5304   assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) &&
5305          "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
5306 
5307   TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
5308   if (D.isInvalidType())
5309     return ExprError();
5310 
5311   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5312     // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
5313     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
5314   } else {
5315     // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with.
5316     ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr);
5317     if (!Res.isUsable())
5318       return ExprError();
5319     CastExpr = Res.get();
5320   }
5321 
5322   checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
5323 
5324   QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
5325   Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
5326 
5327   bool isVectorLiteral = false;
5328 
5329   // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
5330   // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
5331   ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
5332   ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
5333   if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().OpenCL)
5334        && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
5335     if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
5336       Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
5337       return ExprError();
5338     }
5339     if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
5340       Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
5341       if (!E->getType()->isVectorType())
5342         isVectorLiteral = true;
5343     }
5344     else
5345       isVectorLiteral = true;
5346   }
5347 
5348   // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
5349   // then handle it as such.
5350   if (isVectorLiteral)
5351     return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
5352 
5353   // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
5354   // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
5355   // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
5356   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
5357     ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
5358     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5359     CastExpr = Result.get();
5360   }
5361 
5362   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() &&
5363       !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc))
5364     Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange();
5365 
5366   CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr);
5367 
5368   CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr);
5369 
5370   return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
5371 }
5372 
5373 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5374                                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
5375                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
5376   assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
5377          "Expected paren or paren list expression");
5378 
5379   Expr **exprs;
5380   unsigned numExprs;
5381   Expr *subExpr;
5382   SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc;
5383   if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
5384     LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc();
5385     LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc();
5386     exprs = PE->getExprs();
5387     numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
5388   } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance
5389     LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen();
5390     LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen();
5391     subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
5392     exprs = &subExpr;
5393     numExprs = 1;
5394   }
5395 
5396   QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
5397   assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
5398 
5399   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
5400   const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>();
5401   unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements();
5402 
5403   // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
5404   // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
5405   // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
5406   // replicated to all the components of the vector
5407   if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) {
5408     // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
5409     // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
5410     // be replicated to all the components of the vector
5411     if (numExprs == 1) {
5412       QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5413       ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5414       if (Literal.isInvalid())
5415         return ExprError();
5416       Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5417                                   PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5418       return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5419     }
5420     else if (numExprs < numElems) {
5421       Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
5422            diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
5423       return ExprError();
5424     }
5425     else
5426       initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5427   }
5428   else {
5429     // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
5430     // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
5431     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5432         VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
5433         numExprs == 1) {
5434         QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5435         ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5436         if (Literal.isInvalid())
5437           return ExprError();
5438         Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5439                                     PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5440         return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5441     }
5442 
5443     initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5444   }
5445   // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
5446   // braces instead of the original commas.
5447   InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc,
5448                                                    initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc);
5449   initE->setType(Ty);
5450   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
5451 }
5452 
5453 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn
5454 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators.
5455 ExprResult
5456 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
5457   ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
5458   if (!E)
5459     return OrigExpr;
5460 
5461   ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
5462 
5463   for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
5464     Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
5465                         E->getExpr(i));
5466 
5467   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5468 
5469   return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
5470 }
5471 
5472 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
5473                                     SourceLocation R,
5474                                     MultiExprArg Val) {
5475   Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R);
5476   return expr;
5477 }
5478 
5479 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
5480 /// constant and the other is not a pointer.  Returns true if a diagnostic is
5481 /// emitted.
5482 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
5483                                       SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5484   Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
5485   Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
5486   Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
5487       NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5488                                       Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5489 
5490   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
5491     NullExpr = RHSExpr;
5492     NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
5493     NullKind =
5494         NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5495                                         Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5496   }
5497 
5498   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
5499     return false;
5500 
5501   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression)
5502     return false;
5503 
5504   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) {
5505     // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
5506     // string in the source code.
5507     NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
5508     SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
5509     if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
5510       return false;
5511   }
5512 
5513   int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr);
5514   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
5515       << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
5516       << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
5517   return true;
5518 }
5519 
5520 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
5521 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5522   QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
5523 
5524   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type.
5525   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) {
5526     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
5527       << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5528     return true;
5529   }
5530 
5531   // C99 6.5.15p2
5532   if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
5533 
5534   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
5535     << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5536   return true;
5537 }
5538 
5539 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type.
5540 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5541                                          ExprResult &RHS) {
5542     Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get();
5543     Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get();
5544 
5545     if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5546       S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5547         << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5548     if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5549       S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5550         << LHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5551     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5552     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5553     return S.Context.VoidTy;
5554 }
5555 
5556 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
5557 /// true otherwise.
5558 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
5559                                         QualType PointerTy) {
5560   if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
5561       !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
5562                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5563     return true;
5564 
5565   NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
5566   return false;
5567 }
5568 
5569 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
5570 /// type.
5571 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5572                                                      ExprResult &RHS,
5573                                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
5574   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5575   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5576 
5577   if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
5578     // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
5579     return LHSTy;
5580   }
5581 
5582   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
5583 
5584   // Get the pointee types.
5585   bool IsBlockPointer = false;
5586   if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
5587     lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
5588     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5589     IsBlockPointer = true;
5590   } else {
5591     lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5592     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5593   }
5594 
5595   // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to
5596   // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
5597   // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite
5598   // type.
5599 
5600   // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified
5601   // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should
5602   // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or
5603   // anything.
5604   Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers();
5605   Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers();
5606 
5607   unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers();
5608   lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5609   rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5610 
5611   lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual);
5612   rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual);
5613 
5614   QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee);
5615 
5616   if (CompositeTy.isNull()) {
5617     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
5618       << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5619       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5620     // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
5621     // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
5622     // to get a consistent AST.
5623     QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5624     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5625     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5626     return incompatTy;
5627   }
5628 
5629   // The pointer types are compatible.
5630   QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
5631   if (IsBlockPointer)
5632     ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy);
5633   else
5634     ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy);
5635 
5636   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5637   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5638   return ResultTy;
5639 }
5640 
5641 /// \brief Returns true if QT is quelified-id and implements 'NSObject' and/or
5642 /// 'NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else); or QT is an NSObject and optionally
5643 /// implements 'NSObject' and/or NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else).
5644 static bool isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, QualType QT) {
5645   if (QT->isObjCIdType())
5646     return true;
5647 
5648   const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5649   if (!OPT)
5650     return false;
5651 
5652   if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5653     if (ID->getIdentifier() != &C.Idents.get("NSObject"))
5654       return false;
5655 
5656   ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSCopying =
5657     S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSCopying"), SourceLocation());
5658   ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSObject =
5659     S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSObject"), SourceLocation());
5660 
5661   for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5662     if ((PNSCopying && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSCopying)) ||
5663         (PNSObject && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSObject)))
5664       ;
5665     else
5666       return false;
5667   }
5668   return true;
5669 }
5670 
5671 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
5672 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
5673                                                           ExprResult &LHS,
5674                                                           ExprResult &RHS,
5675                                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
5676   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5677   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5678 
5679   if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
5680     if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5681       QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5682       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5683       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5684       return destType;
5685     }
5686     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5687       << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5688       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5689     return QualType();
5690   }
5691 
5692   // We have 2 block pointer types.
5693   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5694 }
5695 
5696 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
5697 static QualType
5698 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5699                                             ExprResult &RHS,
5700                                             SourceLocation Loc) {
5701   // get the pointer types
5702   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5703   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5704 
5705   // get the "pointed to" types
5706   QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5707   QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5708 
5709   // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
5710   if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5711     // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
5712     QualType destPointee
5713       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5714     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5715     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5716     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5717     // Promote to void*.
5718     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5719     return destType;
5720   }
5721   if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5722     QualType destPointee
5723       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5724     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5725     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5726     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5727     // Promote to void*.
5728     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5729     return destType;
5730   }
5731 
5732   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5733 }
5734 
5735 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
5736 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
5737 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
5738                                         Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
5739                                         bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
5740   if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
5741       !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
5742     return false;
5743 
5744   Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
5745   Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
5746 
5747   S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
5748     << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
5749     << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
5750   Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(),
5751                             CK_IntegralToPointer);
5752   return true;
5753 }
5754 
5755 /// \brief Simple conversion between integer and floating point types.
5756 ///
5757 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5758 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5759 ///
5760 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar
5761 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two
5762 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result
5763 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No
5764 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use
5765 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always
5766 /// promotes promotable types.
5767 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5768                                             ExprResult &RHS,
5769                                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5770   LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
5771   if (LHS.isInvalid())
5772     return QualType();
5773   RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
5774   if (RHS.isInvalid())
5775     return QualType();
5776 
5777   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
5778   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
5779   QualType LHSType =
5780     S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5781   QualType RHSType =
5782     S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5783 
5784   if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5785     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5786       << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5787     return QualType();
5788   }
5789 
5790   if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5791     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5792       << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5793     return QualType();
5794   }
5795 
5796   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
5797   if (LHSType == RHSType)
5798     return LHSType;
5799 
5800   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
5801   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
5802     return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
5803                                  /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5804 
5805   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
5806   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
5807   (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5808 }
5809 
5810 /// \brief Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the
5811 ///        condition in length.
5812 ///
5813 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5814 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5815 ///
5816 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands
5817 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted
5818 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition
5819 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result
5820 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits.
5821 static QualType
5822 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
5823                               QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5824   QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
5825   if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
5826 
5827   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5828   assert(CV);
5829 
5830   // Determine the vector result type
5831   unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements();
5832   QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements);
5833 
5834   // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits
5835   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType())
5836       != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) {
5837     // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print
5838     // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description.
5839     std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString();
5840     SmallString<64> Str;
5841     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
5842     OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)";
5843     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
5844       << CondTy << OS.str();
5845     return QualType();
5846   }
5847 
5848   // Convert operands to the vector result type
5849   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
5850   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
5851 
5852   return VectorTy;
5853 }
5854 
5855 /// \brief Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector
5856 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond,
5857                                        SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5858   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of
5859   // integral type.
5860   const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
5861   assert(CondTy);
5862   QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType();
5863   if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false;
5864 
5865   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
5866     << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange();
5867   return true;
5868 }
5869 
5870 /// \brief Return false if the vector condition type and the vector
5871 ///        result type are compatible.
5872 ///
5873 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same
5874 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number
5875 /// of bits.
5876 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy,
5877                               SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5878   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5879   const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5880   assert(CV && RV);
5881 
5882   if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) {
5883     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size)
5884       << CondTy << VecResTy;
5885     return true;
5886   }
5887 
5888   QualType CVE = CV->getElementType();
5889   QualType RVE = RV->getElementType();
5890 
5891   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) {
5892     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
5893       << CondTy << VecResTy;
5894     return true;
5895   }
5896 
5897   return false;
5898 }
5899 
5900 /// \brief Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in
5901 ///        OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1
5902 ///        s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type.
5903 static QualType
5904 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond,
5905                              ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
5906                              SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5907   Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get());
5908   if (Cond.isInvalid())
5909     return QualType();
5910   QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
5911 
5912   if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
5913     return QualType();
5914 
5915   // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the
5916   // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i.
5917   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
5918       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5919     QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
5920                                               /*isCompAssign*/false);
5921     if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
5922     // The result type must match the condition type as specified in
5923     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6.
5924     if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc))
5925       return QualType();
5926     return VecResTy;
5927   }
5928 
5929   // Both operands are scalar.
5930   return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc);
5931 }
5932 
5933 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
5934 /// In that case, LHS = cond.
5935 /// C99 6.5.15
5936 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
5937                                         ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
5938                                         ExprObjectKind &OK,
5939                                         SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5940 
5941   ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
5942   if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
5943   LHS = LHSResult;
5944 
5945   ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
5946   if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
5947   RHS = RHSResult;
5948 
5949   // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
5950   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5951     return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
5952 
5953   VK = VK_RValue;
5954   OK = OK_Ordinary;
5955 
5956   // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently
5957   // different to merit its own checker.
5958   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
5959     return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
5960 
5961   // First, check the condition.
5962   Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get());
5963   if (Cond.isInvalid())
5964     return QualType();
5965   if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
5966     return QualType();
5967 
5968   // Now check the two expressions.
5969   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
5970       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
5971     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
5972 
5973   QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
5974   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
5975     return QualType();
5976 
5977   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5978   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5979 
5980   // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
5981   // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
5982   if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
5983     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy));
5984     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy));
5985 
5986     return ResTy;
5987   }
5988 
5989   // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
5990   // type.
5991   if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {    // C99 6.5.15p3
5992     if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
5993       if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
5994         // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
5995         // that type."  This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
5996         return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
5997     // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
5998   }
5999 
6000   // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
6001   // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
6002   if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
6003     return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS);
6004   }
6005 
6006   // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
6007   // the type of the other operand."
6008   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
6009   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
6010 
6011   // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
6012   QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
6013                                                         QuestionLoc);
6014   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
6015     return QualType();
6016   if (!compositeType.isNull())
6017     return compositeType;
6018 
6019 
6020   // Handle block pointer types.
6021   if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
6022     return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6023                                                      QuestionLoc);
6024 
6025   // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
6026   if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
6027     return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6028                                                        QuestionLoc);
6029 
6030   // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.  Note that
6031   // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
6032   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6033       /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true))
6034     return RHSTy;
6035   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6036       /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false))
6037     return LHSTy;
6038 
6039   // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
6040   // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
6041   // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
6042   if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
6043     return QualType();
6044 
6045   // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
6046   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6047     << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6048     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6049   return QualType();
6050 }
6051 
6052 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
6053 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
6054 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
6055                                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6056   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6057   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
6058 
6059   // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*.  Here we case the result
6060   // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
6061   // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
6062   if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6063       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6064     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6065     return LHSTy;
6066   }
6067   if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6068       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6069     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6070     return RHSTy;
6071   }
6072   // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
6073   if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6074       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6075     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6076     return LHSTy;
6077   }
6078   if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6079       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6080     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6081     return RHSTy;
6082   }
6083   // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
6084   if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
6085       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6086     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6087     return LHSTy;
6088   }
6089   if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
6090       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6091     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6092     return RHSTy;
6093   }
6094   // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
6095   if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6096 
6097     if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
6098       // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
6099       return LHSTy;
6100     }
6101     const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6102     const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6103     QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
6104 
6105     // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
6106     // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
6107     // type. This allows
6108     //   xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
6109     // where B is a subclass of A.
6110     //
6111     // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
6112     // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
6113     // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
6114     // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
6115 
6116     // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
6117     // It could return the composite type.
6118     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
6119       compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
6120     } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
6121       compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
6122     } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
6123                 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
6124                Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
6125       // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
6126       // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
6127       // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
6128       // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
6129       compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6130     } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
6131       compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6132     } else if (!(compositeType =
6133                  Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
6134       ;
6135     else {
6136       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6137       << LHSTy << RHSTy
6138       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6139       QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
6140       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6141       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6142       return incompatTy;
6143     }
6144     // The object pointer types are compatible.
6145     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6146     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6147     return compositeType;
6148   }
6149   // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
6150   if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6151     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6152       // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6153       // so these types are not compatible.
6154       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6155           << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6156       LHS = RHS = true;
6157       return QualType();
6158     }
6159     QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6160     QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6161     QualType destPointee
6162     = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
6163     QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6164     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6165     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6166     // Promote to void*.
6167     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6168     return destType;
6169   }
6170   if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
6171     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6172       // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6173       // so these types are not compatible.
6174       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6175           << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6176       LHS = RHS = true;
6177       return QualType();
6178     }
6179     QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6180     QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6181     QualType destPointee
6182     = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
6183     QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6184     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6185     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6186     // Promote to void*.
6187     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6188     return destType;
6189   }
6190   return QualType();
6191 }
6192 
6193 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
6194 /// ParenRange in parentheses.
6195 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6196                                const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
6197                                SourceRange ParenRange) {
6198   SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
6199   if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
6200       EndLoc.isValid()) {
6201     Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
6202       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6203       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
6204   } else {
6205     // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
6206     Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
6207   }
6208 }
6209 
6210 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6211   return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr;
6212 }
6213 
6214 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
6215 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
6216 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
6217 /// expression.
6218 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
6219                                    Expr **RHSExprs) {
6220   // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
6221   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6222   E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator();
6223   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6224 
6225   // Built-in binary operator.
6226   if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
6227     if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
6228       *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
6229       *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
6230       return true;
6231     }
6232   }
6233 
6234   // Overloaded operator.
6235   if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
6236     if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
6237       return false;
6238 
6239     // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
6240     // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
6241     OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
6242     if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow ||
6243         OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus)
6244       return false;
6245 
6246     BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
6247     if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
6248       *Opcode = OpKind;
6249       *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
6250       return true;
6251     }
6252   }
6253 
6254   return false;
6255 }
6256 
6257 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6258   return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr);
6259 }
6260 
6261 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
6262 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
6263 /// commonly interpreted as boolean.
6264 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) {
6265   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6266 
6267   if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
6268     return true;
6269   if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
6270     return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode());
6271   if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
6272     return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
6273   if (E->getType()->isPointerType())
6274     return true;
6275 
6276   return false;
6277 }
6278 
6279 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
6280 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
6281 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
6282 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
6283 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self,
6284                                           SourceLocation OpLoc,
6285                                           Expr *Condition,
6286                                           Expr *LHSExpr,
6287                                           Expr *RHSExpr) {
6288   BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
6289   Expr *CondRHS;
6290 
6291   if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
6292     return;
6293   if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
6294     return;
6295 
6296   // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
6297   // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
6298 
6299   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional)
6300       << Condition->getSourceRange()
6301       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
6302 
6303   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6304     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
6305       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
6306     SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd()));
6307 
6308   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6309     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
6310     SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
6311 }
6312 
6313 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation.  Note that 'LHS' may be null
6314 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
6315 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
6316                                     SourceLocation ColonLoc,
6317                                     Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
6318                                     Expr *RHSExpr) {
6319   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6320     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it
6321     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
6322     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
6323     ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr);
6324     if (!CondResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6325     CondExpr = CondResult.get();
6326   }
6327 
6328   // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
6329   // was the condition.
6330   OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr;
6331   Expr *commonExpr = nullptr;
6332   if (!LHSExpr) {
6333     commonExpr = CondExpr;
6334     // Lower out placeholder types first.  This is important so that we don't
6335     // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such
6336     // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax.
6337     if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6338       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr);
6339       if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6340       commonExpr = result.get();
6341     }
6342     // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
6343     // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
6344     if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
6345           && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
6346           && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
6347           && commonExpr->isGLValue()
6348           && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6349           && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6350           && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
6351       ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
6352       if (commonRes.isInvalid())
6353         return ExprError();
6354       commonExpr = commonRes.get();
6355     }
6356 
6357     opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
6358                                                 commonExpr->getType(),
6359                                                 commonExpr->getValueKind(),
6360                                                 commonExpr->getObjectKind(),
6361                                                 commonExpr);
6362     LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
6363   }
6364 
6365   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
6366   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
6367   ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
6368   QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
6369                                              VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
6370   if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
6371       RHS.isInvalid())
6372     return ExprError();
6373 
6374   DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
6375                                 RHS.get());
6376 
6377   if (!commonExpr)
6378     return new (Context)
6379         ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc,
6380                             RHS.get(), result, VK, OK);
6381 
6382   return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator(
6383       commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6384       ColonLoc, result, VK, OK);
6385 }
6386 
6387 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
6388 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
6389 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
6390 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
6391 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
6392 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6393 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6394   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6395   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6396 
6397   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6398   const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
6399   Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
6400   std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
6401       cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6402   std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
6403       cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6404 
6405   Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6406 
6407   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
6408   // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
6409   // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
6410 
6411   // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
6412   if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
6413       lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
6414     // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
6415     lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6416     rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6417   }
6418 
6419   if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) {
6420     // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal.  TODO: address subspaces
6421     if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq))
6422       ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6423 
6424     // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
6425     // and from void*.
6426     else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()
6427                         .compatiblyIncludes(
6428                                 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime())
6429              && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
6430       ; // keep old
6431 
6432     // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
6433     else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
6434       ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6435 
6436     // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
6437     // as still compatible in C.
6438     else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6439   }
6440 
6441   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
6442   // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
6443   // version of void...
6444   if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
6445     if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6446       return ConvTy;
6447 
6448     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6449     assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
6450     return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6451   }
6452 
6453   if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
6454     if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6455       return ConvTy;
6456 
6457     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6458     assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
6459     return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6460   }
6461 
6462   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
6463   // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
6464   QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
6465   if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
6466     // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
6467     // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
6468     // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
6469     if (lhptee->isCharType())
6470       ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6471     else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6472       ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
6473 
6474     if (rhptee->isCharType())
6475       rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6476     else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6477       rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
6478 
6479     if (ltrans == rtrans) {
6480       // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
6481       // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
6482       // warning can be disabled.
6483       if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible)
6484         return ConvTy;
6485 
6486       return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign;
6487     }
6488 
6489     // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
6490     // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
6491     // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
6492     // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
6493     if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
6494       do {
6495         lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6496         rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6497       } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
6498 
6499       if (lhptee == rhptee)
6500         return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
6501     }
6502 
6503     // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
6504     return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6505   }
6506   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6507       S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans))
6508     return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6509   return ConvTy;
6510 }
6511 
6512 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
6513 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
6514 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
6515 // types.
6516 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6517 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6518                                     QualType RHSType) {
6519   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6520   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6521 
6522   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
6523 
6524   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6525   lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
6526   rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
6527 
6528   // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
6529   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6530     return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6531 
6532   Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6533 
6534   // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
6535   if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers())
6536     ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6537 
6538   if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6539     return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6540 
6541   return ConvTy;
6542 }
6543 
6544 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
6545 /// for assignment compatibility.
6546 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6547 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6548                                    QualType RHSType) {
6549   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
6550   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
6551 
6552   if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6553     // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
6554     if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6555         !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6556       return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6557     return Sema::Compatible;
6558   }
6559   if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6560     if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6561         !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6562       return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6563     return Sema::Compatible;
6564   }
6565   QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6566   QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6567 
6568   if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) &&
6569       // make an exception for id<P>
6570       !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6571     return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6572 
6573   if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6574     return Sema::Compatible;
6575   if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6576     return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
6577   return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6578 }
6579 
6580 Sema::AssignConvertType
6581 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
6582                                  QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6583   // Fake up an opaque expression.  We don't actually care about what
6584   // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
6585   // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
6586   // usually happen on valid code.
6587   OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue);
6588   ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
6589   CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
6590 
6591   return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K);
6592 }
6593 
6594 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
6595 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
6596 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
6597 ///
6598 ///  int a, *pint;
6599 ///  short *pshort;
6600 ///  struct foo *pfoo;
6601 ///
6602 ///  pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6603 ///  a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
6604 ///  pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
6605 ///  pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6606 ///
6607 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
6608 /// C99 spec dictates.
6609 ///
6610 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
6611 Sema::AssignConvertType
6612 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
6613                                  CastKind &Kind) {
6614   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
6615   QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
6616 
6617   // Get canonical types.  We're not formatting these types, just comparing
6618   // them.
6619   LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6620   RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6621 
6622   // Common case: no conversion required.
6623   if (LHSType == RHSType) {
6624     Kind = CK_NoOp;
6625     return Compatible;
6626   }
6627 
6628   // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an
6629   // atomic qualification step.
6630   if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) {
6631     Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6632       CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind);
6633     if (result != Compatible)
6634       return result;
6635     if (Kind != CK_NoOp)
6636       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind);
6637     Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic;
6638     return Compatible;
6639   }
6640 
6641   // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
6642   // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
6643   // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
6644   // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
6645   // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
6646   // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
6647   // type.
6648   if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6649     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
6650       Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
6651       return Compatible;
6652     }
6653     return Incompatible;
6654   }
6655 
6656   // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
6657   // to the same ExtVector type.
6658   if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
6659     if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
6660       return Incompatible;
6661     if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
6662       // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
6663       // element type.
6664       QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType();
6665       if (elType != RHSType) {
6666         Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType);
6667         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind);
6668       }
6669       Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
6670       return Compatible;
6671     }
6672   }
6673 
6674   // Conversions to or from vector type.
6675   if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6676     if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6677       // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
6678       // vector type and vice versa
6679       if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
6680         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6681         return Compatible;
6682       }
6683 
6684       // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
6685       // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
6686       // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
6687       if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
6688         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6689         return IncompatibleVectors;
6690       }
6691     }
6692     return Incompatible;
6693   }
6694 
6695   // Arithmetic conversions.
6696   if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
6697       !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
6698     Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
6699     return Compatible;
6700   }
6701 
6702   // Conversions to normal pointers.
6703   if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
6704     // U* -> T*
6705     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6706       unsigned AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6707       unsigned AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6708       Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
6709       return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6710     }
6711 
6712     // int -> T*
6713     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6714       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
6715       return IntToPointer;
6716     }
6717 
6718     // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6719     // with two exceptions:
6720     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
6721       //  - conversions to void*
6722       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6723         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6724         return Compatible;
6725       }
6726 
6727       //  - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
6728       if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6729           Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
6730                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6731         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6732         return Compatible;
6733       }
6734 
6735       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6736       return IncompatiblePointer;
6737     }
6738 
6739     // U^ -> void*
6740     if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
6741       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6742         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6743         return Compatible;
6744       }
6745     }
6746 
6747     return Incompatible;
6748   }
6749 
6750   // Conversions to block pointers.
6751   if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6752     // U^ -> T^
6753     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
6754       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6755       return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6756     }
6757 
6758     // int or null -> T^
6759     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6760       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6761       return IntToBlockPointer;
6762     }
6763 
6764     // id -> T^
6765     if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
6766       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6767       return Compatible;
6768     }
6769 
6770     // void* -> T^
6771     if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
6772       if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6773         Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6774         return Compatible;
6775       }
6776 
6777     return Incompatible;
6778   }
6779 
6780   // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
6781   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6782     // A* -> B*
6783     if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6784       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6785       Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6786         checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6787       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6788           result == Compatible &&
6789           !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
6790         result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
6791       return result;
6792     }
6793 
6794     // int or null -> A*
6795     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6796       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6797       return IntToPointer;
6798     }
6799 
6800     // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6801     // with two exceptions:
6802     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6803       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6804 
6805       //  - conversions from 'void*'
6806       if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
6807         return Compatible;
6808       }
6809 
6810       //  - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
6811       if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6812           Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
6813                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6814         return Compatible;
6815       }
6816 
6817       return IncompatiblePointer;
6818     }
6819 
6820     // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer.
6821     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
6822         isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(*this, Context, LHSType)) {
6823       maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS);
6824       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6825       return Compatible;
6826     }
6827 
6828     return Incompatible;
6829   }
6830 
6831   // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
6832   if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6833     // T* -> _Bool
6834     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
6835       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
6836       return Compatible;
6837     }
6838 
6839     // T* -> int
6840     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6841       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
6842       return PointerToInt;
6843     }
6844 
6845     return Incompatible;
6846   }
6847 
6848   // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
6849   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
6850     // T* -> _Bool
6851     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
6852       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
6853       return Compatible;
6854     }
6855 
6856     // T* -> int
6857     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6858       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
6859       return PointerToInt;
6860     }
6861 
6862     return Incompatible;
6863   }
6864 
6865   // struct A -> struct B
6866   if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
6867     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
6868       Kind = CK_NoOp;
6869       return Compatible;
6870     }
6871   }
6872 
6873   return Incompatible;
6874 }
6875 
6876 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
6877 /// used to initialize the transparent union.
6878 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
6879                                       ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
6880                                       FieldDecl *Field) {
6881   // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
6882   // of the transparent union.
6883   Expr *E = EResult.get();
6884   InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
6885                                                    E, SourceLocation());
6886   Initializer->setType(UnionType);
6887   Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
6888 
6889   // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
6890   // union type from this initializer list.
6891   TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
6892   EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
6893                                         VK_RValue, Initializer, false);
6894 }
6895 
6896 Sema::AssignConvertType
6897 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
6898                                                ExprResult &RHS) {
6899   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
6900 
6901   // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
6902   // transparent_union GCC extension.
6903   const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
6904   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
6905     return Incompatible;
6906 
6907   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
6908   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6909   FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr;
6910   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
6911   for (auto *it : UD->fields()) {
6912     if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
6913       // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
6914       // 1) void pointer
6915       // 2) null pointer constant
6916       if (RHSType->isPointerType())
6917         if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6918           RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
6919           InitField = it;
6920           break;
6921         }
6922 
6923       if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
6924                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
6925         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(),
6926                                 CK_NullToPointer);
6927         InitField = it;
6928         break;
6929       }
6930     }
6931 
6932     CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
6933     if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind)
6934           == Compatible) {
6935       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind);
6936       InitField = it;
6937       break;
6938     }
6939   }
6940 
6941   if (!InitField)
6942     return Incompatible;
6943 
6944   ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
6945   return Compatible;
6946 }
6947 
6948 Sema::AssignConvertType
6949 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
6950                                        bool Diagnose,
6951                                        bool DiagnoseCFAudited) {
6952   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6953     if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
6954       // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
6955       // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
6956       // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
6957       ExprResult Res;
6958       if (Diagnose) {
6959         Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
6960                                         AA_Assigning);
6961       } else {
6962         ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6963             TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
6964                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
6965                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
6966                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6967                                   /*CStyle=*/false,
6968                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
6969         if (ICS.isFailure())
6970           return Incompatible;
6971         Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
6972                                         ICS, AA_Assigning);
6973       }
6974       if (Res.isInvalid())
6975         return Incompatible;
6976       Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible;
6977       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6978           !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType,
6979                                                  RHS.get()->getType()))
6980         result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
6981       RHS = Res;
6982       return result;
6983     }
6984 
6985     // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
6986     // structures.
6987     // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
6988     // happen there, though.
6989   }
6990 
6991   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
6992   // a null pointer constant.
6993   if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
6994        LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) &&
6995       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
6996                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
6997     CastKind Kind;
6998     CXXCastPath Path;
6999     CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false);
7000     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path);
7001     return Compatible;
7002   }
7003 
7004   // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
7005   // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
7006   // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
7007   // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
7008   //
7009   // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
7010   if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
7011     RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7012     if (RHS.isInvalid())
7013       return Incompatible;
7014   }
7015 
7016   Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts();
7017   if (ObjCProtocolExpr *OPE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) {
7018     ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = OPE->getProtocol();
7019     if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) {
7020       Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl->getName();
7021       Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl;
7022     }
7023   }
7024 
7025   CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
7026   Sema::AssignConvertType result =
7027     CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind);
7028 
7029   // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
7030   // type of the assignment expression.
7031   // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
7032   // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
7033   // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
7034   // does not have reference type.
7035   if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) {
7036     QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7037     Expr *E = RHS.get();
7038     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
7039       CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion,
7040                              DiagnoseCFAudited);
7041     if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 &&
7042         (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(),
7043                                           LHSType, E->getType(), E) ||
7044          ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) {
7045       RHS = E;
7046       return Compatible;
7047     }
7048 
7049     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind);
7050   }
7051   return result;
7052 }
7053 
7054 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
7055                                ExprResult &RHS) {
7056   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
7057     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7058     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7059   return QualType();
7060 }
7061 
7062 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting
7063 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat.
7064 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar
7065 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except
7066 /// for float->int.
7067 ///
7068 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions
7069 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure)
7070 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar,
7071                                      QualType scalarTy,
7072                                      QualType vectorEltTy,
7073                                      QualType vectorTy) {
7074   // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
7075   // if necessary.
7076   CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid;
7077 
7078   if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
7079     if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7080       return true;
7081     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7082         S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7083       return true;
7084     scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
7085   } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7086     if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7087       if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7088           S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7089         return true;
7090       scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
7091     }
7092     else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7093       scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
7094     else
7095       return true;
7096   } else {
7097     return true;
7098   }
7099 
7100   // Adjust scalar if desired.
7101   if (scalar) {
7102     if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid)
7103       *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast);
7104     *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
7105   }
7106   return false;
7107 }
7108 
7109 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7110                                    SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7111   if (!IsCompAssign) {
7112     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
7113     if (LHS.isInvalid())
7114       return QualType();
7115   }
7116   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7117   if (RHS.isInvalid())
7118     return QualType();
7119 
7120   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
7121   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
7122   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7123   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7124 
7125   // If the vector types are identical, return.
7126   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
7127     return LHSType;
7128 
7129   const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7130   const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7131   assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType);
7132 
7133   // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type.
7134   if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
7135       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
7136     if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7137       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
7138       return LHSType;
7139     }
7140 
7141     if (!IsCompAssign)
7142       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
7143     return RHSType;
7144   }
7145 
7146   // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to
7147   // the vector element type and splat.
7148   if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7149     if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType,
7150                                   LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType))
7151       return LHSType;
7152   }
7153   if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) {
7154     if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS),
7155                                   LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(),
7156                                   RHSType))
7157       return RHSType;
7158   }
7159 
7160   // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size
7161   // needs to be the same.
7162   // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this?
7163   // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily?
7164   if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
7165     QualType resultType = LHSType;
7166     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast);
7167     return resultType;
7168   }
7169 
7170   // Okay, the expression is invalid.
7171 
7172   // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that.
7173   if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) ||
7174       (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) {
7175     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
7176       << LHSType << RHSType
7177       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7178     return QualType();
7179   }
7180 
7181   // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic.
7182   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
7183     << LHSType << RHSType
7184     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7185   return QualType();
7186 }
7187 
7188 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
7189 // expression.  These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
7190 // integer instead of a pointer.
7191 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7192                                 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
7193   // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
7194   // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
7195   // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
7196   bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7197   bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7198 
7199   QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
7200 
7201   // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
7202   // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
7203   if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
7204       NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
7205     return;
7206 
7207   // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
7208   // what the other expression is.
7209   if (!IsCompare) {
7210     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
7211         << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7212         << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
7213     return;
7214   }
7215 
7216   // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
7217   // if the other expression is a pointer.
7218   if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
7219       NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
7220     return;
7221 
7222   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
7223       << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
7224       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7225 }
7226 
7227 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7228                                            SourceLocation Loc,
7229                                            bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
7230   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7231 
7232   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7233       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
7234     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7235 
7236   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7237   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7238     return QualType();
7239 
7240 
7241   if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType())
7242     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7243 
7244   // Check for division by zero.
7245   llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7246   if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7247       RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7248     DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7249                         PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
7250                           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7251 
7252   return compType;
7253 }
7254 
7255 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
7256   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7257   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7258 
7259   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7260       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7261     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
7262         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7263       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7264     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7265   }
7266 
7267   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7268   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7269     return QualType();
7270 
7271   if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType())
7272     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7273 
7274   // Check for remainder by zero.
7275   llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7276   if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7277       RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7278     DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7279                         PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
7280                           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7281 
7282   return compType;
7283 }
7284 
7285 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
7286 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7287                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7288   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7289                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7290                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7291     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7292                             << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7293 }
7294 
7295 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
7296 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7297                                             Expr *Pointer) {
7298   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7299                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7300                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7301     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7302 }
7303 
7304 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
7305 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7306                                                     Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
7307   assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7308   assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7309   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7310                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7311                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7312     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7313     // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
7314     << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
7315                                                    RHS->getType())
7316     << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7317     << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
7318 }
7319 
7320 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
7321 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7322                                                 Expr *Pointer) {
7323   assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7324   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7325                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7326                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7327     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
7328     << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
7329     << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7330 }
7331 
7332 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
7333 ///
7334 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
7335 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7336                                                  Expr *Operand) {
7337   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7338   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7339     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7340 
7341   assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType());
7342   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7343   return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
7344                                diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type,
7345                                PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange());
7346 }
7347 
7348 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
7349 ///
7350 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
7351 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
7352 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
7353 /// extension.
7354 ///
7355 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
7356 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7357                                             Expr *Operand) {
7358   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7359   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7360     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7361 
7362   if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
7363 
7364   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7365   if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
7366     diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7367     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7368   }
7369   if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
7370     diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7371     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7372   }
7373 
7374   if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
7375 
7376   return true;
7377 }
7378 
7379 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
7380 /// operands.
7381 ///
7382 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
7383 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
7384 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
7385 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
7386 ///
7387 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
7388 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7389                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7390   bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7391   bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7392   if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
7393 
7394   QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
7395   if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7396   if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7397 
7398   // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces
7399   if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) {
7400     const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7401     const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7402     if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) {
7403       S.Diag(Loc,
7404              diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
7405           << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/
7406           << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7407       return false;
7408     }
7409   }
7410 
7411   // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
7412   bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7413   bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7414   if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
7415     if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7416     else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
7417     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7418 
7419     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7420   }
7421 
7422   bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7423   bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7424   if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
7425     if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7426     else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
7427                                                                 RHSExpr);
7428     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7429 
7430     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7431   }
7432 
7433   if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr))
7434     return false;
7435   if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr))
7436     return false;
7437 
7438   return true;
7439 }
7440 
7441 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string
7442 /// literal.
7443 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7444                                   Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7445   StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7446   Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr;
7447   if (!StrExpr) {
7448     StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7449     IndexExpr = LHSExpr;
7450   }
7451 
7452   bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr &&
7453       IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
7454   if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent())
7455     return;
7456 
7457   llvm::APSInt index;
7458   if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) {
7459     unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1;
7460     if (index.isNonNegative() &&
7461         index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull),
7462                               index.isUnsigned()))
7463       return;
7464   }
7465 
7466   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7467   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int)
7468       << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
7469 
7470   // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str".
7471   if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) {
7472     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7473     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7474         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7475         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7476         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7477   } else
7478     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7479 }
7480 
7481 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string.
7482 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7483                                    Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7484   const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr;
7485   const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr =
7486       dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7487 
7488   if (!CharExpr) {
7489     CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7490     StringRefExpr = RHSExpr;
7491   }
7492 
7493   if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr)
7494     return;
7495 
7496   const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType();
7497 
7498   // Return if not a PointerType.
7499   if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType())
7500     return;
7501 
7502   // Return if not a CharacterType.
7503   if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType())
7504     return;
7505 
7506   ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext();
7507   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7508 
7509   const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType();
7510   if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() &&
7511       CharType->isIntegerType() &&
7512       llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) {
7513     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7514         << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy;
7515   } else {
7516     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7517         << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType();
7518   }
7519 
7520   // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str.
7521   if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) {
7522     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7523     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7524         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7525         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7526         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7527   } else {
7528     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7529   }
7530 }
7531 
7532 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
7533 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7534                                            Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7535   assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7536   assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7537   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
7538     << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7539     << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7540 }
7541 
7542 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
7543     ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7544     QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7545   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7546 
7547   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7548       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7549     QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
7550     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7551     return compType;
7552   }
7553 
7554   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7555   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7556     return QualType();
7557 
7558   // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal".
7559   if (Opc == BO_Add) {
7560     diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7561     diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7562   }
7563 
7564   // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7565   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7566     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7567     return compType;
7568   }
7569 
7570   // Type-checking.  Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp;
7571   // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer.
7572   Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
7573 
7574   bool isObjCPointer;
7575   if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7576     isObjCPointer = false;
7577   } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7578     isObjCPointer = true;
7579   } else {
7580     std::swap(PExp, IExp);
7581     if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7582       isObjCPointer = false;
7583     } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7584       isObjCPointer = true;
7585     } else {
7586       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7587     }
7588   }
7589   assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7590 
7591   if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
7592     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7593 
7594   if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
7595     return QualType();
7596 
7597   if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp))
7598     return QualType();
7599 
7600   // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7601   CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
7602 
7603   if (CompLHSTy) {
7604     QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
7605     if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
7606       LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7607       if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
7608         LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
7609     }
7610     *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
7611   }
7612 
7613   return PExp->getType();
7614 }
7615 
7616 // C99 6.5.6
7617 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7618                                         SourceLocation Loc,
7619                                         QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7620   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7621 
7622   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7623       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7624     QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
7625     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7626     return compType;
7627   }
7628 
7629   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7630   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7631     return QualType();
7632 
7633   // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
7634 
7635   // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7636   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7637     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7638     return compType;
7639   }
7640 
7641   // Either ptr - int   or   ptr - ptr.
7642   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
7643     QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
7644 
7645     // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
7646     if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
7647         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7648       return QualType();
7649 
7650     // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
7651     if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
7652       if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7653         return QualType();
7654 
7655       // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7656       CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr,
7657                        /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true);
7658 
7659       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7660       return LHS.get()->getType();
7661     }
7662 
7663     // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
7664     if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
7665           = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7666       QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
7667 
7668       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7669         // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
7670         if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
7671           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7672         }
7673       } else {
7674         // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
7675         if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
7676                 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
7677                 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
7678           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7679           return QualType();
7680         }
7681       }
7682 
7683       if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
7684                                                LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
7685         return QualType();
7686 
7687       // The pointee type may have zero size.  As an extension, a structure or
7688       // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length.  In this
7689       // case subtraction does not make sense.
7690       if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
7691         CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee);
7692         if (ElementSize.isZero()) {
7693           Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types)
7694             << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType()
7695             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7696         }
7697       }
7698 
7699       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7700       return Context.getPointerDiffType();
7701     }
7702   }
7703 
7704   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7705 }
7706 
7707 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
7708   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7709     return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
7710   return false;
7711 }
7712 
7713 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7714                                    SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7715                                    QualType LHSType) {
7716   // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined),
7717   // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema.
7718   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
7719     return;
7720 
7721   llvm::APSInt Right;
7722   // Check right/shifter operand
7723   if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7724       !RHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, S.Context))
7725     return;
7726 
7727   if (Right.isNegative()) {
7728     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7729                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
7730                             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7731     return;
7732   }
7733   llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
7734                        S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType()));
7735   if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) {
7736     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7737                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
7738                             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7739     return;
7740   }
7741   if (Opc != BO_Shl)
7742     return;
7743 
7744   // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
7745   // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned
7746   // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value
7747   // representable in the result type, so never warn for those.
7748   llvm::APSInt Left;
7749   if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7750       !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) ||
7751       LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation())
7752     return;
7753   llvm::APInt ResultBits =
7754       static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits();
7755   if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits))
7756     return;
7757   llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
7758   Result = Result.shl(Right);
7759 
7760   // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
7761   // hexadecimal number.
7762   SmallString<40> HexResult;
7763   Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
7764 
7765   // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
7766   // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
7767   // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
7768   // turned off separately if needed.
7769   if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) {
7770     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
7771         << HexResult.str() << LHSType
7772         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7773     return;
7774   }
7775 
7776   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
7777     << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType
7778     << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
7779     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7780 }
7781 
7782 // C99 6.5.7
7783 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7784                                   SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7785                                   bool IsCompAssign) {
7786   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7787 
7788   // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
7789   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7790       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
7791     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7792 
7793   // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
7794   // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
7795 
7796   // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
7797   // if this is a compound assignment.
7798   ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
7799   LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
7800   if (LHS.isInvalid())
7801     return QualType();
7802   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
7803   if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
7804 
7805   // The RHS is simpler.
7806   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
7807   if (RHS.isInvalid())
7808     return QualType();
7809   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
7810 
7811   // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
7812   if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
7813       !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7814     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7815 
7816   // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
7817   // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
7818   if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) ||
7819       isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) {
7820     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7821   }
7822   // Sanity-check shift operands
7823   DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
7824 
7825   // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
7826   return LHSType;
7827 }
7828 
7829 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
7830   if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
7831     if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
7832       return true;
7833     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
7834       return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
7835   }
7836   return false;
7837 }
7838 
7839 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning.
7840 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS,
7841                                 Expr *RHS) {
7842   QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
7843   QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
7844 
7845   const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
7846   if (!LHSEnumType)
7847     return;
7848   const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
7849   if (!RHSEnumType)
7850     return;
7851 
7852   // Ignore anonymous enums.
7853   if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
7854     return;
7855   if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
7856     return;
7857 
7858   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType))
7859     return;
7860 
7861   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types)
7862       << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType
7863       << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
7864 }
7865 
7866 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
7867 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7868                                               ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7869                                               bool IsError) {
7870   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
7871                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
7872     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7873     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7874 }
7875 
7876 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
7877 /// true otherwise.
7878 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7879                                            ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
7880   // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
7881   //   [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
7882   //   conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
7883   //   a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
7884   //   them to their composite pointer type. [...]
7885   //
7886   // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
7887   // comparisons of pointers.
7888 
7889   // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
7890   //   In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
7891   //   member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
7892   //   (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
7893   //   them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
7894   //   the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
7895   //   common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
7896   //   of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
7897   //   that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
7898   //   types.
7899 
7900   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
7901   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
7902   assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
7903          (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()));
7904 
7905   bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
7906   bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType;
7907   QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr);
7908   if (T.isNull()) {
7909     diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
7910     return true;
7911   }
7912 
7913   if (NonStandardCompositeType)
7914     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
7915       << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
7916       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7917 
7918   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
7919   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
7920   return false;
7921 }
7922 
7923 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7924                                                     ExprResult &LHS,
7925                                                     ExprResult &RHS,
7926                                                     bool IsError) {
7927   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
7928                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
7929     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7930     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7931 }
7932 
7933 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) {
7934   switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) {
7935   case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
7936   case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
7937   case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
7938   case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass:
7939     return true;
7940   default:
7941     // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal!
7942     return false;
7943   }
7944 }
7945 
7946 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) {
7947   const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type =
7948     LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7949 
7950   // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out.
7951   if (!Type)
7952     return false;
7953 
7954   // Get the LHS object's interface type.
7955   QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType();
7956   if (const ObjCObjectType *iQFaceTy =
7957       InterfaceType->getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType())
7958     InterfaceType = iQFaceTy->getBaseType();
7959 
7960   // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out.
7961   if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
7962     return false;
7963 
7964   // Try to find the -isEqual: method.
7965   Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector();
7966   ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel,
7967                                                       InterfaceType,
7968                                                       /*instance=*/true);
7969   if (!Method) {
7970     if (Type->isObjCIdType()) {
7971       // For 'id', just check the global pool.
7972       Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(),
7973                                                   /*receiverId=*/true,
7974                                                   /*warn=*/false);
7975     } else {
7976       // Check protocols.
7977       Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type,
7978                                              /*instance=*/true);
7979     }
7980   }
7981 
7982   if (!Method)
7983     return false;
7984 
7985   QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType();
7986   if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType())
7987     return false;
7988 
7989   QualType R = Method->getReturnType();
7990   if (!R->isScalarType())
7991     return false;
7992 
7993   return true;
7994 }
7995 
7996 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) {
7997   FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
7998   switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) {
7999     default:
8000       break;
8001     case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
8002       // "string literal"
8003       return LK_String;
8004     case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
8005       // "array literal"
8006       return LK_Array;
8007     case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
8008       // "dictionary literal"
8009       return LK_Dictionary;
8010     case Stmt::BlockExprClass:
8011       return LK_Block;
8012     case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: {
8013       Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
8014       switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) {
8015         case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass:
8016         case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass:
8017         case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass:
8018         case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass:
8019         case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass:
8020           // "numeric literal"
8021           return LK_Numeric;
8022         case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
8023           CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind();
8024           // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts.
8025           if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast)
8026             return LK_Numeric;
8027           break;
8028         }
8029         default:
8030           break;
8031       }
8032       return LK_Boxed;
8033     }
8034   }
8035   return LK_None;
8036 }
8037 
8038 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8039                                           ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8040                                           BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){
8041   Expr *Literal;
8042   Expr *Other;
8043   if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) {
8044     Literal = LHS.get();
8045     Other = RHS.get();
8046   } else {
8047     Literal = RHS.get();
8048     Other = LHS.get();
8049   }
8050 
8051   // Don't warn on comparisons against nil.
8052   Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts();
8053   if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(),
8054                                    Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
8055     return;
8056 
8057   // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison.
8058   // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own
8059   // warning flag.
8060   Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal);
8061   assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block);
8062   if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) {
8063     llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind");
8064   }
8065 
8066   if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String)
8067     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison)
8068       << Literal->getSourceRange();
8069   else
8070     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison)
8071       << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange();
8072 
8073   if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
8074       hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) {
8075     SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8076     SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
8077     CharSourceRange OpRange =
8078       CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
8079 
8080     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal)
8081       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![")
8082       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:")
8083       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]");
8084   }
8085 }
8086 
8087 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8088                                                 ExprResult &RHS,
8089                                                 SourceLocation Loc,
8090                                                 unsigned OpaqueOpc) {
8091   // This checking requires bools.
8092   if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return;
8093 
8094   // Check that left hand side is !something.
8095   UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts());
8096   if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return;
8097 
8098   // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type.
8099   if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8100 
8101   // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool.
8102   Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
8103   if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8104 
8105   // Emit warning.
8106   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison)
8107       << Loc;
8108 
8109   // First note suggest !(x < y)
8110   SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart();
8111   SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8112   FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose);
8113   if (FirstClose.isInvalid())
8114     FirstOpen = SourceLocation();
8115   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix)
8116       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(")
8117       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")");
8118 
8119   // Second note suggests (!x) < y
8120   SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8121   SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8122   SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose);
8123   if (SecondClose.isInvalid())
8124     SecondOpen = SourceLocation();
8125   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens)
8126       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(")
8127       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")");
8128 }
8129 
8130 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable,
8131 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference.
8132 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) {
8133   if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
8134     return DR->getDecl();
8135   if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) {
8136     if (Ivar->isFreeIvar())
8137       return Ivar->getDecl();
8138   }
8139   if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
8140     if (Mem->isImplicitAccess())
8141       return Mem->getMemberDecl();
8142   }
8143   return nullptr;
8144 }
8145 
8146 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
8147 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8148                                     SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc,
8149                                     bool IsRelational) {
8150   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true);
8151 
8152   BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
8153 
8154   // Handle vector comparisons separately.
8155   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8156       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8157     return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational);
8158 
8159   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8160   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8161 
8162   Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8163   Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8164 
8165   checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8166   diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc);
8167 
8168   if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8169       !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) &&
8170       !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8171       !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8172       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8173     // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8174     // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
8175     // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8176     //
8177     // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
8178     // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
8179     // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
8180     // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
8181     // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
8182     // result.
8183     ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped);
8184     ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped);
8185     if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) {
8186       DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8187                           << 0 // self-
8188                           << (Opc == BO_EQ
8189                               || Opc == BO_LE
8190                               || Opc == BO_GE));
8191     } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() &&
8192                !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
8193                !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
8194         // what is it always going to eval to?
8195         char always_evals_to;
8196         switch(Opc) {
8197         case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
8198           always_evals_to = 0; // false
8199           break;
8200         case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
8201           always_evals_to = 1; // true
8202           break;
8203         default:
8204           // best we can say is 'a constant'
8205           always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
8206           break;
8207         }
8208         DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8209                             << 1 // array
8210                             << always_evals_to);
8211     }
8212 
8213     if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
8214       LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8215     if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
8216       RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8217 
8218     // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
8219     // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
8220     Expr *literalString = nullptr;
8221     Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr;
8222     if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
8223         !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8224                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8225       literalString = LHS.get();
8226       literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
8227     } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
8228                 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
8229                !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8230                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8231       literalString = RHS.get();
8232       literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
8233     }
8234 
8235     if (literalString) {
8236       DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8237         PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
8238           << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
8239           << literalString->getSourceRange());
8240     }
8241   }
8242 
8243   // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
8244   UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
8245   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
8246     return QualType();
8247 
8248   LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8249   RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8250 
8251   // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
8252   QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8253 
8254   if (IsRelational) {
8255     if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType())
8256       return ResultTy;
8257   } else {
8258     // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8259     if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8260       CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8261 
8262     if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType())
8263       return ResultTy;
8264   }
8265 
8266   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind =
8267       LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8268   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind =
8269       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8270   bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8271   bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8272 
8273   if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
8274     bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ;
8275     if (RHSIsNull)
8276       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8277                                    RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8278     else
8279       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8280                                    LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8281   }
8282 
8283   // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
8284   // when handling null pointer constants.
8285   if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
8286     QualType LCanPointeeTy =
8287       LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8288     QualType RCanPointeeTy =
8289       RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8290 
8291     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8292       if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
8293         return ResultTy;
8294       if (!IsRelational &&
8295           (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8296         // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8297         // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
8298         // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
8299         // conformance with the C++ standard.
8300         if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8301             && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8302           diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
8303               *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext());
8304 
8305           if (isSFINAEContext())
8306             return QualType();
8307 
8308           RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8309           return ResultTy;
8310         }
8311       }
8312 
8313       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8314         return QualType();
8315       else
8316         return ResultTy;
8317     }
8318     // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
8319     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
8320                                    RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
8321       // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
8322       if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
8323         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
8324           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8325           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8326       }
8327     } else if (!IsRelational &&
8328                (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8329       // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8330       if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8331           && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8332         diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8333                                                 /*isError*/false);
8334     } else {
8335       // Invalid
8336       diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
8337     }
8338     if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
8339       const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8340       if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) {
8341         Diag(Loc,
8342              diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
8343             << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */
8344             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8345       }
8346       unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8347       unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8348       CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion
8349                                                : CK_BitCast;
8350       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8351         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind);
8352       else
8353         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind);
8354     }
8355     return ResultTy;
8356   }
8357 
8358   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8359     // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
8360     if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType())
8361       return ResultTy;
8362 
8363     // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
8364     // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
8365     if (RHSIsNull &&
8366         ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8367          (!IsRelational &&
8368           (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8369       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8370                         LHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8371                           ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8372                           : CK_NullToPointer);
8373       return ResultTy;
8374     }
8375     if (LHSIsNull &&
8376         ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8377          (!IsRelational &&
8378           (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8379       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8380                         RHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8381                           ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8382                           : CK_NullToPointer);
8383       return ResultTy;
8384     }
8385 
8386     // Comparison of member pointers.
8387     if (!IsRelational &&
8388         LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) {
8389       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8390         return QualType();
8391       else
8392         return ResultTy;
8393     }
8394 
8395     // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote
8396     // to integers.
8397     if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() &&
8398         Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(),
8399                                        RHS.get()->getType()))
8400       return ResultTy;
8401   }
8402 
8403   // Handle block pointer types.
8404   if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
8405       RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8406     QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8407     QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8408 
8409     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
8410         !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
8411       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8412         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8413         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8414     }
8415     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8416     return ResultTy;
8417   }
8418 
8419   // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
8420   if (!IsRelational
8421       && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
8422           || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
8423     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8424       if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8425              ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
8426             || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8427                 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
8428         Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8429           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8430           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8431     }
8432     if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8433       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8434                               RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8435                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8436     else
8437       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8438                               LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8439                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8440     return ResultTy;
8441   }
8442 
8443   if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
8444       RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8445     const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8446     const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8447     if (LPT || RPT) {
8448       bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8449       bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8450 
8451       if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
8452           !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
8453         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8454                                           /*isError*/false);
8455       }
8456       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8457         Expr *E = LHS.get();
8458         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8459           CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion);
8460         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType,
8461                                 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8462       }
8463       else {
8464         Expr *E = RHS.get();
8465         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8466           CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false,
8467                                  Opc);
8468         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType,
8469                                 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8470       }
8471       return ResultTy;
8472     }
8473     if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
8474         RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8475       if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
8476         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8477                                           /*isError*/false);
8478       if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS))
8479         diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc);
8480 
8481       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8482         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
8483       else
8484         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8485       return ResultTy;
8486     }
8487   }
8488   if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8489       (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
8490     unsigned DiagID = 0;
8491     bool isError = false;
8492     if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) {
8493       // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers,
8494       // since users tend to want to compare addresses.
8495     } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8496         (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
8497       if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8498         DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
8499     } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8500       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8501     else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8502       DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8503       isError = true;
8504     } else
8505       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8506 
8507     if (DiagID) {
8508       Diag(Loc, DiagID)
8509         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8510         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8511       if (isError)
8512         return QualType();
8513     }
8514 
8515     if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
8516       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8517                         LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8518     else
8519       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8520                         RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8521     return ResultTy;
8522   }
8523 
8524   // Handle block pointers.
8525   if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull
8526       && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
8527     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8528     return ResultTy;
8529   }
8530   if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull
8531       && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8532     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8533     return ResultTy;
8534   }
8535 
8536   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8537 }
8538 
8539 
8540 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements.
8541 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size
8542 // and number of elements.
8543 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) {
8544   const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>();
8545   unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
8546   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy))
8547     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8548   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
8549     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8550   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
8551     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8552   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
8553     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8554   assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
8555          "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
8556   return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8557 }
8558 
8559 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
8560 /// operates on extended vector types.  Instead of producing an IntTy result,
8561 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
8562 /// types.
8563 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8564                                           SourceLocation Loc,
8565                                           bool IsRelational) {
8566   // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
8567   // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
8568   QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
8569   if (vType.isNull())
8570     return vType;
8571 
8572   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8573 
8574   // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
8575   // bool for C++, int for C
8576   if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector)
8577     return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8578 
8579   // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8580   // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
8581   // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8582   if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8583       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8584     if (DeclRefExpr* DRL
8585           = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8586       if (DeclRefExpr* DRR
8587             = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8588         if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
8589           DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8590                               PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8591                                 << 0 // self-
8592                                 << 2 // "a constant"
8593                               );
8594   }
8595 
8596   // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8597   if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
8598     assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
8599     CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8600   }
8601 
8602   // Return a signed type for the vector.
8603   return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType);
8604 }
8605 
8606 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8607                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
8608   // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or
8609   // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type.
8610   QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false);
8611   if (vType.isNull())
8612     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8613   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 &&
8614       vType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8615     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8616 
8617   return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType());
8618 }
8619 
8620 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
8621   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
8622   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
8623 
8624   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8625       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8626     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
8627         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8628       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
8629 
8630     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8631   }
8632 
8633   ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS;
8634   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult,
8635                                                  IsCompAssign);
8636   if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
8637     return QualType();
8638   LHS = LHSResult.get();
8639   RHS = RHSResult.get();
8640 
8641   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
8642     return compType;
8643   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8644 }
8645 
8646 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
8647   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
8648 
8649   // Check vector operands differently.
8650   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8651     return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc);
8652 
8653   // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
8654   // bitwise one.  We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
8655   // is a constant.
8656   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
8657       !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8658       RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
8659       // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
8660       !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8661     // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
8662     // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
8663     // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
8664     // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
8665     llvm::APSInt Result;
8666     if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
8667       if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8668            !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) ||
8669           (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) {
8670         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
8671           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8672           << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
8673         // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
8674         Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
8675             << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
8676             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(
8677                 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(),
8678                                                 getLangOpts())),
8679                                             Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
8680         if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
8681           // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
8682           Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
8683               << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
8684                   SourceRange(
8685                       Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(),
8686                                                  0, getSourceManager(),
8687                                                  getLangOpts()),
8688                       RHS.get()->getLocEnd()));
8689       }
8690   }
8691 
8692   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8693     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do
8694     // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types.
8695     if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
8696         Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
8697       if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() ||
8698           RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType())
8699         return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8700     }
8701 
8702     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
8703     if (LHS.isInvalid())
8704       return QualType();
8705 
8706     RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
8707     if (RHS.isInvalid())
8708       return QualType();
8709 
8710     if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
8711         !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
8712       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8713 
8714     return Context.IntTy;
8715   }
8716 
8717   // The following is safe because we only use this method for
8718   // non-overloadable operands.
8719 
8720   // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
8721   // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
8722   // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
8723   ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
8724   if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
8725     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8726   LHS = LHSRes;
8727 
8728   ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
8729   if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
8730     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8731   RHS = RHSRes;
8732 
8733   // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
8734   // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
8735   // The result is a bool.
8736   return Context.BoolTy;
8737 }
8738 
8739 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
8740   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
8741   if (!ME) return false;
8742   if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false;
8743   ObjCMessageExpr *Base =
8744     dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
8745   if (!Base) return false;
8746   return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr;
8747 }
8748 
8749 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a
8750 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become
8751 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block?
8752 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda };
8753 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
8754   assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified());
8755   E = E->IgnoreParens();
8756 
8757   // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope.
8758   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
8759   if (!DRE) return NCCK_None;
8760   if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None;
8761 
8762   // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'.
8763   VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
8764   if (!var) return NCCK_None;
8765   if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None;
8766   assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?");
8767 
8768   // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
8769   DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr;
8770   while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) {
8771     Prev = DC;
8772     DC = DC->getParent();
8773   }
8774   // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far.
8775   if (!var->isInitCapture())
8776     DC = Prev;
8777   return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda);
8778 }
8779 
8780 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue.  If not,
8781 /// emit an error and return true.  If so, return false.
8782 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
8783   assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
8784   SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
8785   Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
8786                                                               &Loc);
8787   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
8788     IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
8789   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
8790     return false;
8791 
8792   unsigned DiagID = 0;
8793   bool NeedType = false;
8794   switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
8795   case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
8796     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const;
8797 
8798     // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object
8799     // from an enclosing function or block.
8800     if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) {
8801       if (NCCK == NCCK_Block)
8802         DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
8803       else
8804         DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
8805       break;
8806     }
8807 
8808     // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
8809     // infer 'const'.  These are always pseudo-strong variables.
8810     if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
8811       DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
8812       if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
8813         VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
8814 
8815         // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
8816         // user actually wrote 'const'.
8817         if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
8818             (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
8819              !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
8820           // There are two pseudo-strong cases:
8821           //  - self
8822           ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
8823           if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl())
8824             DiagID = method->isClassMethod()
8825               ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method
8826               : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self;
8827 
8828           //  - fast enumeration variables
8829           else
8830             DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
8831 
8832           SourceRange Assign;
8833           if (Loc != OrigLoc)
8834             Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
8835           S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
8836           // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
8837           // can do its job.
8838           return false;
8839         }
8840       }
8841     }
8842 
8843     break;
8844   case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
8845   case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary:
8846     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
8847     NeedType = true;
8848     break;
8849   case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
8850     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
8851     NeedType = true;
8852     break;
8853   case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
8854     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
8855     break;
8856   case Expr::MLV_Valid:
8857     llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
8858   case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
8859   case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
8860   case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
8861     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
8862     break;
8863   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
8864   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
8865     return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
8866              diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E);
8867   case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
8868     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
8869     break;
8870   case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
8871     llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently");
8872   case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
8873     DiagID = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment;
8874     break;
8875   case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
8876     DiagID = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
8877     break;
8878   }
8879 
8880   SourceRange Assign;
8881   if (Loc != OrigLoc)
8882     Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
8883   if (NeedType)
8884     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
8885   else
8886     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
8887   return true;
8888 }
8889 
8890 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
8891                                          SourceLocation Loc,
8892                                          Sema &Sema) {
8893   // C / C++ fields
8894   MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr);
8895   MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr);
8896   if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) {
8897     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))
8898       Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0;
8899   }
8900 
8901   // Objective-C instance variables
8902   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
8903   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
8904   if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) {
8905     DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
8906     DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
8907     if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl())
8908       Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1;
8909   }
8910 }
8911 
8912 // C99 6.5.16.1
8913 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
8914                                        SourceLocation Loc,
8915                                        QualType CompoundType) {
8916   assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
8917 
8918   // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
8919   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
8920     return QualType();
8921 
8922   QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
8923   QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
8924                                              CompoundType;
8925   AssignConvertType ConvTy;
8926   if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
8927     Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
8928 
8929     CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this);
8930 
8931     QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
8932     ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
8933     if (RHS.isInvalid())
8934       return QualType();
8935     // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
8936     if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
8937         ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
8938           RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
8939          (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
8940           LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
8941       ConvTy = Compatible;
8942 
8943     if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
8944         LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
8945         Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment)
8946           << LHSType;
8947 
8948     // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
8949     // right next to each other.  If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
8950     // instead of "x += 4".
8951     if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
8952       RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
8953     if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
8954       if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
8955            UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
8956           Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
8957           // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
8958           Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
8959           // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
8960           // unary +/-.  We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
8961           Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
8962           UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
8963         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
8964           << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
8965           << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
8966       }
8967     }
8968 
8969     if (ConvTy == Compatible) {
8970       if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) {
8971         // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but
8972         // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is
8973         // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference!
8974         const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
8975         const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS);
8976         if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
8977           checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
8978 
8979         // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
8980         // Although this code can still have problems:
8981         //   id x = self.weakProp;
8982         //   id y = self.weakProp;
8983         // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
8984         // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
8985         // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
8986         if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
8987                              RHS.get()->getLocStart()))
8988           getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get());
8989 
8990       } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
8991         checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
8992       }
8993     }
8994   } else {
8995     // Compound assignment "x += y"
8996     ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
8997   }
8998 
8999   if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
9000                                RHS.get(), AA_Assigning))
9001     return QualType();
9002 
9003   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
9004 
9005   // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
9006   // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
9007   // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
9008   // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
9009   // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
9010   // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
9011   // operand.
9012   return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
9013           ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
9014 }
9015 
9016 // C99 6.5.17
9017 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
9018                                    SourceLocation Loc) {
9019   LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
9020   RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
9021   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
9022     return QualType();
9023 
9024   // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
9025   // operands, but not unary promotions.
9026   // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
9027 
9028   // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
9029   // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
9030   LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get());
9031   if (LHS.isInvalid())
9032     return QualType();
9033 
9034   S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get());
9035 
9036   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9037     RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
9038     if (RHS.isInvalid())
9039       return QualType();
9040     if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
9041       S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
9042                             diag::err_incomplete_type);
9043   }
9044 
9045   return RHS.get()->getType();
9046 }
9047 
9048 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
9049 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
9050 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
9051                                                ExprValueKind &VK,
9052                                                ExprObjectKind &OK,
9053                                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
9054                                                bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) {
9055   if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9056     return S.Context.DependentTy;
9057 
9058   QualType ResType = Op->getType();
9059   // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic
9060   // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of
9061   // checking.
9062   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
9063     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
9064 
9065   assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
9066 
9067   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
9068     // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
9069     if (!IsInc) {
9070       S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9071       return QualType();
9072     }
9073     // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
9074     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9075   } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) {
9076     // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode
9077     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType;
9078     return QualType();
9079   } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
9080     // OK!
9081   } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) {
9082     // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
9083     if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
9084       return QualType();
9085   } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9086     // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden.
9087     // Otherwise, we just need a complete type.
9088     if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) ||
9089         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op))
9090       return QualType();
9091   } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
9092     // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
9093     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
9094       << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
9095   } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
9096     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9097     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9098     return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
9099                                           IsInc, IsPrefix);
9100   } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
9101     // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
9102   } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() &&
9103             ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
9104     // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types.
9105   } else {
9106     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
9107       << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
9108     return QualType();
9109   }
9110   // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
9111   // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
9112   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
9113     return QualType();
9114   // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
9115   // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
9116   // operand.
9117   if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9118     VK = VK_LValue;
9119     OK = Op->getObjectKind();
9120     return ResType;
9121   } else {
9122     VK = VK_RValue;
9123     return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
9124   }
9125 }
9126 
9127 
9128 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
9129 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
9130 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
9131 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
9132 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
9133 ///  - &(x) => x
9134 ///  - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
9135 ///  - &s.xx => s
9136 ///  - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
9137 ///  - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
9138 ///  - &"123"[2] -> 0
9139 ///  - & __real__ x -> x
9140 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
9141   switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
9142   case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
9143     return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
9144   case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
9145     // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
9146     // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
9147     // irrelevant.
9148     if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
9149       return nullptr;
9150     // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
9151     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
9152   case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
9153     // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary!  We should catch the implicit
9154     // promotion of register arrays earlier.
9155     Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
9156     if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
9157       if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
9158         return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
9159     }
9160     return nullptr;
9161   }
9162   case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
9163     UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
9164 
9165     switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
9166     case UO_Real:
9167     case UO_Imag:
9168     case UO_Extension:
9169       return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
9170     default:
9171       return nullptr;
9172     }
9173   }
9174   case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
9175     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9176   case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
9177     // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
9178     // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
9179     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9180   default:
9181     return nullptr;
9182   }
9183 }
9184 
9185 namespace {
9186   enum {
9187     AO_Bit_Field = 0,
9188     AO_Vector_Element = 1,
9189     AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
9190     AO_Register_Variable = 3,
9191     AO_No_Error = 4
9192   };
9193 }
9194 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
9195 ///
9196 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
9197 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9198                                          Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
9199   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
9200 }
9201 
9202 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
9203 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
9204 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
9205 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
9206 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
9207 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
9208 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
9209 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9210   if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){
9211     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
9212       Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9213       if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) {
9214         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf);
9215         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function)
9216           << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9217         return QualType();
9218       }
9219 
9220       OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E);
9221       if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl))
9222         if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) {
9223           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9224             << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9225           return QualType();
9226         }
9227 
9228       return Context.OverloadTy;
9229     }
9230 
9231     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny)
9232       return Context.UnknownAnyTy;
9233 
9234     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) {
9235       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9236         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9237       return QualType();
9238     }
9239 
9240     OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get());
9241     if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9242   }
9243 
9244   if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent())
9245     return Context.DependentTy;
9246 
9247   assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType());
9248 
9249   // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
9250   Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9251 
9252   // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
9253   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9254     Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
9255     return QualType();
9256   }
9257 
9258   if (getLangOpts().C99) {
9259     // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
9260     if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
9261       if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
9262         // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
9263         // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
9264         return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
9265     }
9266     // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
9267     // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
9268   }
9269   ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
9270   Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context);
9271   unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
9272 
9273   if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) {
9274     bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext();
9275     Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary
9276                                   : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary)
9277       << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9278     if (sfinae)
9279       return QualType();
9280     // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address.
9281     OrigOp = op = new (Context)
9282         MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true);
9283   } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
9284     return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9285   } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
9286     // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
9287     // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
9288 
9289     // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
9290     if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
9291       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9292         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9293       return QualType();
9294     }
9295     DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
9296     CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
9297 
9298     // The id-expression was parenthesized.
9299     if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) {
9300       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
9301         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9302 
9303     // The method was named without a qualifier.
9304     } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
9305       if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty())
9306         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9307           << op->getSourceRange();
9308       else {
9309         SmallString<32> Str;
9310         StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str);
9311         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9312           << op->getSourceRange()
9313           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual);
9314       }
9315     }
9316 
9317     // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2.
9318     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD))
9319       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange();
9320 
9321     QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9322         op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
9323     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9324       RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9325     return MPTy;
9326   } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9327     // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9328     // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
9329     if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9330       // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references.
9331       if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) {
9332         AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
9333       } else {
9334         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
9335           << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9336         return QualType();
9337       }
9338     }
9339   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9340     // The operand cannot be a bit-field
9341     AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
9342   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
9343     // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
9344     AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
9345   } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9346     // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
9347     // with the register storage-class specifier.
9348     if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
9349       // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
9350       // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
9351       if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
9352           !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9353         AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
9354       }
9355     } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
9356       return Context.OverloadTy;
9357     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
9358       // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
9359       // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
9360       // scope qualifier for the class.
9361       if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
9362         DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
9363         if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
9364           if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
9365             Diag(OpLoc,
9366                  diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
9367               << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
9368             return QualType();
9369           }
9370 
9371           while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
9372             Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
9373 
9374           QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9375               op->getType(),
9376               Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
9377           if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9378             RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9379           return MPTy;
9380         }
9381       }
9382     } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl))
9383       llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
9384   }
9385 
9386   if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
9387     diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
9388     return QualType();
9389   }
9390 
9391   if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9392     // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
9393     // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
9394     // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
9395     Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
9396   }
9397 
9398   // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
9399   if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
9400     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
9401   return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9402 }
9403 
9404 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) {
9405   const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp);
9406   if (!DRE)
9407     return;
9408   const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl();
9409   if (!D)
9410     return;
9411   const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D);
9412   if (!Param)
9413     return;
9414   if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext()))
9415     if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>())
9416       return;
9417   if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction())
9418     if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param))
9419       FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param);
9420 }
9421 
9422 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
9423 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
9424                                         SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9425   if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9426     return S.Context.DependentTy;
9427 
9428   ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
9429   if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
9430     return QualType();
9431   Op = ConvResult.get();
9432   QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
9433   QualType Result;
9434 
9435   if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
9436     QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
9437     S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
9438                                      Op->getSourceRange());
9439   }
9440 
9441   if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
9442     Result = PT->getPointeeType();
9443   else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
9444              OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
9445     Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
9446   else {
9447     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9448     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9449     if (PR.get() != Op)
9450       return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc);
9451   }
9452 
9453   if (Result.isNull()) {
9454     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
9455       << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9456     return QualType();
9457   }
9458 
9459   // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result
9460   // is an incomplete type or void.  It would be possible to warn about
9461   // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
9462   // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid
9463   // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type:
9464   //
9465   // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1:
9466   //   [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall
9467   //   be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type
9468   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType())
9469     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer)
9470       << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9471 
9472   // Dereferences are usually l-values...
9473   VK = VK_LValue;
9474 
9475   // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
9476   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
9477     VK = VK_RValue;
9478 
9479   return Result;
9480 }
9481 
9482 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9483   BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
9484   switch (Kind) {
9485   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
9486   case tok::periodstar:           Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
9487   case tok::arrowstar:            Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
9488   case tok::star:                 Opc = BO_Mul; break;
9489   case tok::slash:                Opc = BO_Div; break;
9490   case tok::percent:              Opc = BO_Rem; break;
9491   case tok::plus:                 Opc = BO_Add; break;
9492   case tok::minus:                Opc = BO_Sub; break;
9493   case tok::lessless:             Opc = BO_Shl; break;
9494   case tok::greatergreater:       Opc = BO_Shr; break;
9495   case tok::lessequal:            Opc = BO_LE; break;
9496   case tok::less:                 Opc = BO_LT; break;
9497   case tok::greaterequal:         Opc = BO_GE; break;
9498   case tok::greater:              Opc = BO_GT; break;
9499   case tok::exclaimequal:         Opc = BO_NE; break;
9500   case tok::equalequal:           Opc = BO_EQ; break;
9501   case tok::amp:                  Opc = BO_And; break;
9502   case tok::caret:                Opc = BO_Xor; break;
9503   case tok::pipe:                 Opc = BO_Or; break;
9504   case tok::ampamp:               Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
9505   case tok::pipepipe:             Opc = BO_LOr; break;
9506   case tok::equal:                Opc = BO_Assign; break;
9507   case tok::starequal:            Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
9508   case tok::slashequal:           Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
9509   case tok::percentequal:         Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
9510   case tok::plusequal:            Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
9511   case tok::minusequal:           Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
9512   case tok::lesslessequal:        Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
9513   case tok::greatergreaterequal:  Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
9514   case tok::ampequal:             Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
9515   case tok::caretequal:           Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
9516   case tok::pipeequal:            Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
9517   case tok::comma:                Opc = BO_Comma; break;
9518   }
9519   return Opc;
9520 }
9521 
9522 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
9523   tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9524   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
9525   switch (Kind) {
9526   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
9527   case tok::plusplus:     Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
9528   case tok::minusminus:   Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
9529   case tok::amp:          Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
9530   case tok::star:         Opc = UO_Deref; break;
9531   case tok::plus:         Opc = UO_Plus; break;
9532   case tok::minus:        Opc = UO_Minus; break;
9533   case tok::tilde:        Opc = UO_Not; break;
9534   case tok::exclaim:      Opc = UO_LNot; break;
9535   case tok::kw___real:    Opc = UO_Real; break;
9536   case tok::kw___imag:    Opc = UO_Imag; break;
9537   case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
9538   }
9539   return Opc;
9540 }
9541 
9542 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
9543 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also
9544 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
9545 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
9546                                    SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9547   if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty())
9548     return;
9549   if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
9550     return;
9551   LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9552   RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9553   const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
9554   const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
9555   if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
9556       LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
9557       RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
9558     return;
9559   const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
9560     cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
9561   const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
9562     cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
9563   if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
9564     return;
9565   if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
9566     return;
9567   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9568     if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
9569       return;
9570 
9571   S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment)
9572       << LHSDeclRef->getType()
9573       << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
9574 }
9575 
9576 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer.  This
9577 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer.
9578 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R,
9579                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9580   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1)
9581     return;
9582 
9583   const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr;
9584   const Expr *LHS = L.get();
9585   const Expr *RHS = R.get();
9586 
9587   if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9588     ObjCPointerExpr = LHS;
9589     OtherExpr = RHS;
9590   }
9591   else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9592     ObjCPointerExpr = RHS;
9593     OtherExpr = LHS;
9594   }
9595 
9596   // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false
9597   // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing.  This logic mainly
9598   // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which
9599   // code should generally never do.
9600   if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9601     unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking;
9602     // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX.
9603     const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
9604     // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which
9605     // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value.
9606     // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase.
9607     if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) {
9608       Selector S = ME->getSelector();
9609       StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0);
9610       if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector"))
9611         Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector;
9612     }
9613 
9614     S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag)
9615       << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
9616   }
9617 }
9618 
9619 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) {
9620   if (!E)
9621     return nullptr;
9622   if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
9623     return DRE->getDecl();
9624   if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
9625     return ME->getMemberDecl();
9626   if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
9627     return IRE->getDecl();
9628   return nullptr;
9629 }
9630 
9631 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
9632 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
9633 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
9634 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
9635                                     BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
9636                                     Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
9637   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) {
9638     // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment,
9639     // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for
9640     // non-assignment operators.
9641     // C++11 5.17p9:
9642     //   The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning
9643     //   of x = {} is x = T().
9644     InitializationKind Kind =
9645         InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart());
9646     InitializedEntity Entity =
9647         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType());
9648     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
9649     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
9650     if (Init.isInvalid())
9651       return Init;
9652     RHSExpr = Init.get();
9653   }
9654 
9655   ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
9656   QualType ResultTy;     // Result type of the binary operator.
9657   // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
9658   QualType CompLHSTy;    // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
9659   QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
9660   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
9661   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
9662 
9663   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9664     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
9665     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
9666     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
9667     LHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr);
9668     RHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) {
9669       if (Opc != BO_Assign)
9670         return ExprResult(E);
9671       // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS.
9672       Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E);
9673       return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E;
9674     });
9675     if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
9676       return ExprError();
9677   }
9678 
9679   switch (Opc) {
9680   case BO_Assign:
9681     ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType());
9682     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9683         LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
9684       VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
9685       OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
9686     }
9687     if (!ResultTy.isNull()) {
9688       DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
9689       DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
9690     }
9691     RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get());
9692     break;
9693   case BO_PtrMemD:
9694   case BO_PtrMemI:
9695     ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
9696                                             Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
9697     break;
9698   case BO_Mul:
9699   case BO_Div:
9700     ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
9701                                            Opc == BO_Div);
9702     break;
9703   case BO_Rem:
9704     ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
9705     break;
9706   case BO_Add:
9707     ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
9708     break;
9709   case BO_Sub:
9710     ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
9711     break;
9712   case BO_Shl:
9713   case BO_Shr:
9714     ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
9715     break;
9716   case BO_LE:
9717   case BO_LT:
9718   case BO_GE:
9719   case BO_GT:
9720     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
9721     break;
9722   case BO_EQ:
9723   case BO_NE:
9724     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false);
9725     break;
9726   case BO_And:
9727     checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
9728   case BO_Xor:
9729   case BO_Or:
9730     ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
9731     break;
9732   case BO_LAnd:
9733   case BO_LOr:
9734     ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
9735     break;
9736   case BO_MulAssign:
9737   case BO_DivAssign:
9738     CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
9739                                                Opc == BO_DivAssign);
9740     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
9741     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9742       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9743     break;
9744   case BO_RemAssign:
9745     CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
9746     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
9747     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9748       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9749     break;
9750   case BO_AddAssign:
9751     CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy);
9752     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9753       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9754     break;
9755   case BO_SubAssign:
9756     CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
9757     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9758       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9759     break;
9760   case BO_ShlAssign:
9761   case BO_ShrAssign:
9762     CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
9763     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
9764     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9765       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9766     break;
9767   case BO_AndAssign:
9768   case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough
9769 	  DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
9770   case BO_XorAssign:
9771     CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
9772     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
9773     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
9774       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
9775     break;
9776   case BO_Comma:
9777     ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
9778     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
9779       VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
9780       OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
9781     }
9782     break;
9783   }
9784   if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
9785     return ExprError();
9786 
9787   // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
9788   CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
9789   CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
9790 
9791   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9792     NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
9793                                                  &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
9794                                                  SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
9795     if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) {
9796       SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
9797       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
9798       FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
9799       FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") <<
9800       FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
9801     }
9802     else
9803       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
9804   }
9805   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
9806            dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()))
9807     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get());
9808 
9809   if (CompResultTy.isNull())
9810     return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK,
9811                                         OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
9812   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
9813       OK_ObjCProperty) {
9814     VK = VK_LValue;
9815     OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
9816   }
9817   return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
9818       LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
9819       OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
9820 }
9821 
9822 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
9823 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
9824 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
9825 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
9826 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
9827                                       SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
9828                                       Expr *RHSExpr) {
9829   BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
9830   BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr);
9831 
9832   // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator.
9833   bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp();
9834   bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp();
9835   if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp)
9836     return;
9837 
9838   // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
9839   // Don't diagnose this.
9840   bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
9841   bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
9842   if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise))
9843     return;
9844 
9845   SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(),
9846                                                    OpLoc)
9847                                      : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
9848   StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr();
9849   SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ?
9850       SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())
9851     : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd());
9852 
9853   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
9854     << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
9855   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
9856     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr,
9857     (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange());
9858   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
9859     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
9860       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
9861     ParensRange);
9862 }
9863 
9864 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one.
9865 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression
9866 /// in parentheses.
9867 static void
9868 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9869                                        BinaryOperator *Bop) {
9870   assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And);
9871   Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or)
9872       << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
9873   SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
9874     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
9875       << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
9876     Bop->getSourceRange());
9877 }
9878 
9879 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
9880 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
9881 /// in parentheses.
9882 static void
9883 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9884                                        BinaryOperator *Bop) {
9885   assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
9886   Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
9887       << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
9888   SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
9889     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
9890       << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
9891     Bop->getSourceRange());
9892 }
9893 
9894 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
9895 /// 'true'.
9896 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
9897   bool Res;
9898   return !E->isValueDependent() &&
9899          E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
9900 }
9901 
9902 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
9903 /// 'false'.
9904 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
9905   bool Res;
9906   return !E->isValueDependent() &&
9907          E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
9908 }
9909 
9910 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
9911 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9912                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
9913   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
9914     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
9915       // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
9916       if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr))
9917         return;
9918       // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
9919       if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
9920         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
9921     } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
9922       if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
9923         // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
9924         // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
9925         if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
9926           return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
9927       }
9928     }
9929   }
9930 }
9931 
9932 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
9933 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9934                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
9935   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
9936     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
9937       // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
9938       if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr))
9939         return;
9940       // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
9941       if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
9942         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
9943     }
9944   }
9945 }
9946 
9947 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr.
9948 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9949                                              Expr *OrArg) {
9950   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) {
9951     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And)
9952       return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
9953   }
9954 }
9955 
9956 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9957                                     Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) {
9958   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
9959     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) {
9960       StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr();
9961       S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift)
9962           << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op;
9963       SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
9964           S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op,
9965           Bop->getSourceRange());
9966     }
9967   }
9968 }
9969 
9970 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9971                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
9972   CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr);
9973   if (!OCE)
9974     return;
9975 
9976   FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee();
9977   if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator())
9978     return;
9979 
9980   OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator();
9981   if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater)
9982     return;
9983 
9984   S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison)
9985       << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange()
9986       << (Kind == OO_LessLess);
9987   SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(),
9988                      S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
9989                          << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"),
9990                      OCE->getSourceRange());
9991   SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc,
9992                      S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first),
9993                      SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(),
9994                                  RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
9995 }
9996 
9997 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
9998 /// precedence.
9999 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10000                                     SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
10001                                     Expr *RHSExpr){
10002   // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
10003   if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
10004     DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10005 
10006   // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
10007   if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10008     DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
10009     DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
10010   }
10011 
10012   // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
10013   // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
10014   if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10015     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10016     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10017   }
10018 
10019   if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext()))
10020       || Opc == BO_Shr) {
10021     StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
10022     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift);
10023     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift);
10024   }
10025 
10026   // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as:
10027   // cout << 5 == 4;
10028   if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc))
10029     DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10030 }
10031 
10032 // Binary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
10033 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
10034                             tok::TokenKind Kind,
10035                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10036   BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
10037   assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
10038   assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
10039 
10040   // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
10041   DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10042 
10043   return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10044 }
10045 
10046 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope.
10047 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10048                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10049                                        Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
10050   // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10051   // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10052   // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10053   // the arguments.
10054   UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10055   OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
10056     = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10057   if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal)
10058     S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(),
10059                                    RHS->getType(), Functions);
10060 
10061   // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
10062   // binary operation.
10063   return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS);
10064 }
10065 
10066 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10067                             BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10068                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10069   // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment
10070   // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if
10071   // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent),
10072   // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case).  We also want to get
10073   // any placeholder types out of the way.
10074 
10075   // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS.
10076   if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10077     // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis.
10078     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10079         BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc))
10080       return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10081 
10082     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10083     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10084       // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder,
10085       // though.  Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that
10086       // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set.  Note
10087       // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never
10088       // instantiates to having an overloadable type.
10089       ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10090       if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10091       RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10092 
10093       if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
10094           RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10095         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10096     }
10097 
10098     ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr);
10099     if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10100     LHSExpr = LHS.get();
10101   }
10102 
10103   // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS.
10104   if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10105     // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type
10106     // being assigned to.
10107     if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10108       if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10109         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10110 
10111       if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10112         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10113 
10114       return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10115     }
10116 
10117     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10118     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload &&
10119         LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10120       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10121 
10122     ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10123     if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
10124     RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10125   }
10126 
10127   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10128     // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an
10129     // overloaded op.
10130     if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10131       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10132 
10133     // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an
10134     // overloadable type.
10135     if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
10136         RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10137       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10138   }
10139 
10140   // Build a built-in binary operation.
10141   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10142 }
10143 
10144 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
10145                                       UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
10146                                       Expr *InputExpr) {
10147   ExprResult Input = InputExpr;
10148   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10149   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10150   QualType resultType;
10151   switch (Opc) {
10152   case UO_PreInc:
10153   case UO_PreDec:
10154   case UO_PostInc:
10155   case UO_PostDec:
10156     resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK,
10157                                                 OpLoc,
10158                                                 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10159                                                 Opc == UO_PostInc,
10160                                                 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10161                                                 Opc == UO_PreDec);
10162     break;
10163   case UO_AddrOf:
10164     resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
10165     RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr);
10166     break;
10167   case UO_Deref: {
10168     Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10169     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10170     resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc);
10171     break;
10172   }
10173   case UO_Plus:
10174   case UO_Minus:
10175     Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10176     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10177     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10178     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10179       break;
10180     if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
10181         resultType->isVectorType())
10182       break;
10183     else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
10184              Opc == UO_Plus &&
10185              resultType->isPointerType())
10186       break;
10187 
10188     return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10189       << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10190 
10191   case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
10192     Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10193     if (Input.isInvalid())
10194       return ExprError();
10195     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10196     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10197       break;
10198     // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
10199     if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
10200       // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
10201       Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
10202           << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
10203     else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
10204       break;
10205     else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10206       if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
10207         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate
10208         // on vector float types.
10209         QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10210         if (!T->isIntegerType())
10211           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10212                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10213       }
10214       break;
10215     } else {
10216       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10217                        << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10218     }
10219     break;
10220 
10221   case UO_LNot: // logical negation
10222     // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
10223     Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10224     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10225     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10226 
10227     // Though we still have to promote half FP to float...
10228     if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) {
10229       Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
10230       resultType = Context.FloatTy;
10231     }
10232 
10233     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10234       break;
10235     if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) {
10236       // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
10237       if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10238         // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
10239         // operand contextually converted to bool.
10240         Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy,
10241                                   ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
10242       } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10243                  Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10244         // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10245         // operate on scalar float types.
10246         if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
10247           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10248                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10249       }
10250     } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10251       if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10252           Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10253         // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10254         // operate on vector float types.
10255         QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10256         if (!T->isIntegerType())
10257           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10258                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10259       }
10260       // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
10261       resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
10262       break;
10263     } else {
10264       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10265         << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10266     }
10267 
10268     // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
10269     // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
10270     resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
10271     break;
10272   case UO_Real:
10273   case UO_Imag:
10274     resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
10275     // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary
10276     // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values.
10277     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10278     if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) {
10279       if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
10280           Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
10281         VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10282     } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10283       // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not.
10284       Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10285     }
10286     break;
10287   case UO_Extension:
10288     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10289     VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10290     OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
10291     break;
10292   }
10293   if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
10294     return ExprError();
10295 
10296   // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
10297   // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
10298   // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
10299   // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
10300   if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
10301     CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
10302 
10303   return new (Context)
10304       UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc);
10305 }
10306 
10307 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member
10308 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member
10309 /// with the address-of operator.
10310 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) {
10311   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
10312     if (!DRE->getQualifier())
10313       return false;
10314 
10315     ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl();
10316     if (!VD->isCXXClassMember())
10317       return false;
10318 
10319     if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
10320       return true;
10321     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD))
10322       return Method->isInstance();
10323 
10324     return false;
10325   }
10326 
10327   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
10328     if (!ULE->getQualifier())
10329       return false;
10330 
10331     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(),
10332                                            DEnd = ULE->decls_end();
10333          D != DEnd; ++D) {
10334       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) {
10335         if (Method->isInstance())
10336           return true;
10337       } else {
10338         // Overload set does not contain methods.
10339         break;
10340       }
10341     }
10342 
10343     return false;
10344   }
10345 
10346   return false;
10347 }
10348 
10349 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10350                               UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) {
10351   // First things first: handle placeholders so that the
10352   // overloaded-operator check considers the right type.
10353   if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10354     // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references.
10355     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10356         UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc))
10357       return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10358 
10359     // extension is always a builtin operator.
10360     if (Opc == UO_Extension)
10361       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10362 
10363     // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder.
10364     // The builtin code knows what to do.
10365     if (Opc == UO_AddrOf &&
10366         (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload ||
10367          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny ||
10368          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember))
10369       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10370 
10371     // Anything else needs to be handled now.
10372     ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input);
10373     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10374     Input = Result.get();
10375   }
10376 
10377   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
10378       UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None &&
10379       !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) {
10380     // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10381     // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10382     // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10383     // the arguments.
10384     UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10385     OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10386     if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
10387       LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
10388                                    Functions);
10389 
10390     return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
10391   }
10392 
10393   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10394 }
10395 
10396 // Unary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
10397 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10398                               tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
10399   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
10400 }
10401 
10402 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
10403 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
10404                                 LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
10405   TheDecl->markUsed(Context);
10406   // Create the AST node.  The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
10407   return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl,
10408                                      Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy));
10409 }
10410 
10411 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether
10412 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an
10413 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the
10414 /// release out of the full-expression.  Otherwise, return null.
10415 /// Cannot fail.
10416 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) {
10417   // Should always be wrapped with one of these.
10418   ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement);
10419   if (!cleanups) return nullptr;
10420 
10421   ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr());
10422   if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject)
10423     return nullptr;
10424 
10425   // Splice out the cast.  This shouldn't modify any interesting
10426   // features of the statement.
10427   Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr();
10428   assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType());
10429   assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind());
10430   cleanups->setSubExpr(producer);
10431   return cleanups;
10432 }
10433 
10434 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() {
10435   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
10436 }
10437 
10438 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() {
10439   // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a
10440   // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything.
10441 
10442   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10443   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10444 }
10445 
10446 ExprResult
10447 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
10448                     SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
10449   assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
10450   CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
10451 
10452   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
10453     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10454   assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!");
10455   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10456 
10457   // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
10458   // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
10459   // More semantic analysis is needed.
10460 
10461   // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
10462   // as the type of the stmtexpr.
10463   QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
10464   bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
10465   if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
10466     Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
10467     LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr;
10468     // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
10469     while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
10470       LastLabelStmt = Label;
10471       LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
10472     }
10473 
10474     if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
10475       // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
10476       // lvalue-to-rvalue.  However, initialize an unqualified type.
10477       ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE);
10478       if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10479         return ExprError();
10480       Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10481 
10482       if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) {
10483         // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
10484         // the consume out and bind it later.  In the alternate case
10485         // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
10486         // initialization will create a produce.  In both cases the
10487         // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
10488         // a bind.
10489         if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt
10490               = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) {
10491           LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt;
10492         } else {
10493           LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization(
10494                             InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
10495                                                                 Ty,
10496                                                                 false),
10497                                                    SourceLocation(),
10498                                                LastExpr);
10499         }
10500 
10501         if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10502           return ExprError();
10503         if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) {
10504           if (!LastLabelStmt)
10505             Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get());
10506           else
10507             LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get());
10508           StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
10509         }
10510       }
10511     }
10512   }
10513 
10514   // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
10515   // expressions are not lvalues.
10516   Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
10517   if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
10518     return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
10519   return ResStmtExpr;
10520 }
10521 
10522 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
10523                                       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
10524                                       OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
10525                                       unsigned NumComponents,
10526                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
10527   QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
10528   bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
10529   SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
10530 
10531   // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
10532   // one is known to be a field designator.  Verify that the ArgTy represents
10533   // a struct/union/class.
10534   if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
10535     return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
10536                        << ArgTy << TypeRange);
10537 
10538   // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
10539   // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
10540   if (!Dependent
10541       && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
10542                              diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange))
10543     return ExprError();
10544 
10545   // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
10546   // GCC extension, diagnose them.
10547   // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
10548   // a system header!
10549   if (NumComponents != 1)
10550     Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
10551       << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
10552 
10553   bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
10554   QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
10555   typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
10556   SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
10557   SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
10558   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
10559     const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
10560     if (OC.isBrackets) {
10561       // Offset of an array sub-field.  TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
10562       if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
10563         const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
10564         if(!AT)
10565           return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
10566                            << CurrentType);
10567         CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
10568       } else
10569         CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
10570 
10571       ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E));
10572       if (IdxRval.isInvalid())
10573         return ExprError();
10574       Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get();
10575 
10576       // The expression must be an integral expression.
10577       // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
10578       if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
10579           !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
10580         return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
10581                               diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
10582                          << Idx->getSourceRange());
10583 
10584       // Record this array index.
10585       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
10586       Exprs.push_back(Idx);
10587       continue;
10588     }
10589 
10590     // Offset of a field.
10591     if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
10592       // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
10593       // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
10594       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
10595       CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
10596       continue;
10597     }
10598 
10599     // We need to have a complete type to look into.
10600     if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
10601                             diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
10602       return ExprError();
10603 
10604     // Look for the designated field.
10605     const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
10606     if (!RC)
10607       return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
10608                        << CurrentType);
10609     RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
10610 
10611     // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
10612     //   The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
10613     //   International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
10614     //   (clause 9).
10615     // C++11 [support.types]p4:
10616     //   If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are
10617     //   undefined.
10618     if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
10619       bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD();
10620       unsigned DiagID =
10621         LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type
10622                             : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type;
10623 
10624       if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
10625           DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr,
10626                               PDiag(DiagID)
10627                               << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
10628                               << CurrentType))
10629         DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
10630     }
10631 
10632     // Look for the field.
10633     LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
10634     LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
10635     FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
10636     IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr;
10637     if (!MemberDecl) {
10638       if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
10639         MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
10640     }
10641 
10642     if (!MemberDecl)
10643       return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
10644                        << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
10645                                                               OC.LocEnd));
10646 
10647     // C99 7.17p3:
10648     //   (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
10649     //
10650     // We diagnose this as an error.
10651     if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
10652       Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
10653         << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
10654         << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
10655       Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
10656       return ExprError();
10657     }
10658 
10659     RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
10660     if (IndirectMemberDecl)
10661       Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
10662 
10663     // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
10664     // the base class indirections.
10665     CXXBasePaths Paths;
10666     if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
10667       if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
10668         Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base)
10669           << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
10670           << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
10671         return ExprError();
10672       }
10673 
10674       CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
10675       for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
10676            B != BEnd; ++B)
10677         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
10678     }
10679 
10680     if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
10681       for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) {
10682         assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI));
10683         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
10684                                      cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd));
10685       }
10686     } else
10687       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
10688 
10689     CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
10690   }
10691 
10692   return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo,
10693                               Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc);
10694 }
10695 
10696 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
10697                                       SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
10698                                       SourceLocation TypeLoc,
10699                                       ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
10700                                       OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
10701                                       unsigned NumComponents,
10702                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
10703 
10704   TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
10705   QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
10706   if (ArgTy.isNull())
10707     return ExprError();
10708 
10709   if (!ArgTInfo)
10710     ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
10711 
10712   return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
10713                               RParenLoc);
10714 }
10715 
10716 
10717 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
10718                                  Expr *CondExpr,
10719                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
10720                                  SourceLocation RPLoc) {
10721   assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
10722 
10723   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10724   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10725   QualType resType;
10726   bool ValueDependent = false;
10727   bool CondIsTrue = false;
10728   if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
10729     resType = Context.DependentTy;
10730     ValueDependent = true;
10731   } else {
10732     // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
10733     llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
10734     ExprResult CondICE
10735       = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval,
10736           diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false);
10737     if (CondICE.isInvalid())
10738       return ExprError();
10739     CondExpr = CondICE.get();
10740     CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue();
10741 
10742     // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
10743     Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
10744 
10745     resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
10746     ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
10747     VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
10748     OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
10749   }
10750 
10751   return new (Context)
10752       ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
10753                  CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent);
10754 }
10755 
10756 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10757 // Clang Extensions.
10758 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10759 
10760 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
10761 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
10762   BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
10763 
10764   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
10765     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
10766     if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx =
10767             getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(),
10768                                           ManglingContextDecl)) {
10769       unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block);
10770       Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl);
10771     }
10772   }
10773 
10774   PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
10775   CurContext->addDecl(Block);
10776   if (CurScope)
10777     PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
10778   else
10779     CurContext = Block;
10780 
10781   getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true;
10782 
10783   // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any
10784   // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression.
10785   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated);
10786 }
10787 
10788 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
10789                                Scope *CurScope) {
10790   assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
10791          "block-id should have no identifier!");
10792   assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext);
10793   BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
10794 
10795   TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
10796   QualType T = Sig->getType();
10797 
10798   // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would,
10799   // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs.
10800   if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) {
10801     // Drop the parameters.
10802     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
10803     EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
10804     EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const;
10805     T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI);
10806     Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
10807   }
10808 
10809   // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
10810   // literal signature.  Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
10811   // unless the function was written with a typedef.
10812   assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
10813          "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
10814 
10815   // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
10816   FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
10817 
10818   TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens();
10819   if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) {
10820 
10821     // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
10822     // GetTypeForDeclarator.  If so, don't save that as part of the
10823     // written signature.
10824     if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
10825         ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
10826       // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
10827       // TypeSourceInfos.
10828       TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc();
10829       unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
10830       Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
10831       Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
10832 
10833       ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
10834     }
10835   }
10836 
10837   CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
10838   CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
10839 
10840   const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>();
10841   QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType();
10842   bool isVariadic =
10843     (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
10844 
10845   CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
10846 
10847   // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
10848   // return type.  TODO:  what should we do with declarators like:
10849   //   ^ * { ... }
10850   // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
10851   if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) {
10852     CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
10853     CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false);
10854     CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false;
10855   }
10856 
10857   // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
10858   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
10859   if (ExplicitSignature) {
10860     for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) {
10861       ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I);
10862       if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
10863           !Param->isImplicit() &&
10864           !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
10865           !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
10866         Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
10867       Params.push_back(Param);
10868     }
10869 
10870   // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
10871   //   ^ fntype { ... }
10872   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10873     for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) {
10874       ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(
10875           CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I);
10876       Params.push_back(Param);
10877     }
10878   }
10879 
10880   // Set the parameters on the block decl.
10881   if (!Params.empty()) {
10882     CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
10883     CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
10884                              CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
10885                              /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
10886   }
10887 
10888   // Finally we can process decl attributes.
10889   ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
10890 
10891   // Put the parameter variables in scope.
10892   for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) {
10893     AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
10894 
10895     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
10896     if (AI->getIdentifier()) {
10897       CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI);
10898 
10899       PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
10900     }
10901   }
10902 }
10903 
10904 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
10905 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
10906 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
10907   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
10908   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10909   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10910 
10911   // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
10912   PopDeclContext();
10913   PopFunctionScopeInfo();
10914 }
10915 
10916 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
10917 /// literal was successfully completed.  ^(int x){...}
10918 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
10919                                     Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
10920   // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
10921   if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
10922     Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
10923 
10924   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
10925   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
10926     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10927   assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!");
10928   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10929 
10930   BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
10931 
10932   if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType)
10933     deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI);
10934 
10935   PopDeclContext();
10936 
10937   QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
10938   if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
10939     RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
10940 
10941   bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
10942   QualType BlockTy;
10943 
10944   // Set the captured variables on the block.
10945   // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo!
10946   SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures;
10947   for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) {
10948     CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i];
10949     if (Cap.isThisCapture())
10950       continue;
10951     BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(),
10952                               Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr());
10953     Captures.push_back(NewCap);
10954   }
10955   BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(),
10956                             BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0);
10957 
10958   // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
10959   if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
10960     const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
10961 
10962     FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
10963     if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
10964 
10965     // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
10966     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
10967       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
10968       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
10969       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
10970 
10971     // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
10972     // preserve its sugar structure.
10973     } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy &&
10974                (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
10975       BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
10976 
10977     // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
10978     } else {
10979       const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
10980       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
10981       EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently?
10982       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
10983       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
10984     }
10985 
10986   // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
10987   } else {
10988     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
10989     EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
10990     BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
10991   }
10992 
10993   DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
10994                            BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
10995   BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
10996 
10997   // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
10998   if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
10999       !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
11000     DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11001 
11002   BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11003 
11004   // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again
11005   // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around
11006   // to deduce an implicit return type.
11007   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() &&
11008       !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext())
11009     computeNRVO(Body, BSI);
11010 
11011   BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
11012   AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
11013   PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result);
11014 
11015   // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at
11016   // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context:
11017   if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) {
11018     // First, this expression has a new cleanup object.
11019     ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl());
11020     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
11021 
11022     // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured
11023     // variables needs destruction.
11024     for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) {
11025       const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable();
11026       if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) {
11027         getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope();
11028         break;
11029       }
11030     }
11031   }
11032 
11033   return Result;
11034 }
11035 
11036 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11037                                         Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
11038                                         SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11039   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
11040   GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
11041   return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
11042 }
11043 
11044 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11045                                 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
11046                                 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11047   Expr *OrigExpr = E;
11048 
11049   // Get the va_list type
11050   QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
11051   if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
11052     // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
11053     // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
11054     // a pointer for va_arg.
11055     VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
11056     // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
11057     ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
11058     if (Result.isInvalid())
11059       return ExprError();
11060     E = Result.get();
11061   } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11062     // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode,
11063     // check the argument using reference binding.
11064     InitializedEntity Entity
11065       = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11066           Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false);
11067     ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E);
11068     if (Init.isInvalid())
11069       return ExprError();
11070     E = Init.getAs<Expr>();
11071   } else {
11072     // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
11073     // it is modified by va_arg.
11074     if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11075         CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
11076       return ExprError();
11077   }
11078 
11079   if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11080       !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
11081     return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
11082                          diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
11083       << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
11084   }
11085 
11086   if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
11087     if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
11088                             diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete,
11089                             TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11090       return ExprError();
11091 
11092     if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11093                                TInfo->getType(),
11094                                diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract,
11095                                TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11096       return ExprError();
11097 
11098     if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
11099       Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11100            TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
11101              ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
11102              : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
11103         << TInfo->getType()
11104         << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
11105     }
11106 
11107     // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
11108     // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
11109     QualType PromoteType;
11110     if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
11111       PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
11112       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType()))
11113         PromoteType = QualType();
11114     }
11115     if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
11116       PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
11117     if (!PromoteType.isNull())
11118       DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
11119                   PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
11120                           << TInfo->getType()
11121                           << PromoteType
11122                           << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
11123   }
11124 
11125   QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11126   return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T);
11127 }
11128 
11129 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
11130   // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
11131   // pointers on the target.
11132   QualType Ty;
11133   unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0);
11134   if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
11135     Ty = Context.IntTy;
11136   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
11137     Ty = Context.LongTy;
11138   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
11139     Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
11140   else {
11141     llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
11142   }
11143 
11144   return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc);
11145 }
11146 
11147 bool
11148 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) {
11149   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
11150     return false;
11151 
11152   const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11153   if (!PT)
11154     return false;
11155 
11156   if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
11157     // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
11158     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
11159     if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
11160       return false;
11161   }
11162 
11163   // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be
11164   // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values.  The last is
11165   // important for making this trigger for property assignments.
11166   Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11167   if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr))
11168     if (OV->getSourceExpr())
11169       SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11170 
11171   StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr);
11172   if (!SL || !SL->isAscii())
11173     return false;
11174   Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix)
11175     << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
11176   Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get();
11177   return true;
11178 }
11179 
11180 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
11181                                     SourceLocation Loc,
11182                                     QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
11183                                     Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
11184                                     bool *Complained) {
11185   if (Complained)
11186     *Complained = false;
11187 
11188   // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
11189   bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
11190   bool isInvalid = false;
11191   unsigned DiagKind = 0;
11192   FixItHint Hint;
11193   ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
11194   bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
11195   bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false;
11196   const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
11197   const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr;
11198 
11199   switch (ConvTy) {
11200   case Compatible:
11201       DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr);
11202       return false;
11203 
11204   case PointerToInt:
11205     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
11206     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11207     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11208     break;
11209   case IntToPointer:
11210     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
11211     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11212     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11213     break;
11214   case IncompatiblePointer:
11215       DiagKind =
11216         (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ?
11217           diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer :
11218           diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer);
11219     CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
11220       SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
11221     if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) {
11222       ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11223     }
11224     else if (CheckInferredResultType) {
11225       SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType();
11226       DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType();
11227     }
11228     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11229     break;
11230   case IncompatiblePointerSign:
11231     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
11232     break;
11233   case FunctionVoidPointer:
11234     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
11235     break;
11236   case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
11237     // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
11238     if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
11239 
11240     Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11241     Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11242     if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
11243       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
11244       break;
11245 
11246 
11247     } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
11248       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
11249       break;
11250     }
11251 
11252     llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
11253     // fallthrough
11254   }
11255   case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
11256     // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
11257     // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
11258     // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2).  FIXME:
11259     // Ideally, this check would be performed in
11260     // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
11261     // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
11262     // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
11263     // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
11264     // C++ semantics.
11265     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
11266         IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
11267       return false;
11268     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
11269     break;
11270   case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
11271     DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
11272     break;
11273   case IntToBlockPointer:
11274     DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
11275     break;
11276   case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
11277     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
11278     break;
11279   case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: {
11280     if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11281       const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT =
11282                 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11283       for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) {
11284         PDecl = srcProto;
11285         break;
11286       }
11287       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11288             DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11289         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11290     }
11291     else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11292       const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT =
11293         DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11294       for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) {
11295         PDecl = dstProto;
11296         break;
11297       }
11298       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11299             SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11300         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11301     }
11302     DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
11303     break;
11304   }
11305   case IncompatibleVectors:
11306     DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
11307     break;
11308   case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
11309     DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
11310     break;
11311   case Incompatible:
11312     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
11313     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11314     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11315     isInvalid = true;
11316     MayHaveFunctionDiff = true;
11317     break;
11318   }
11319 
11320   QualType FirstType, SecondType;
11321   switch (Action) {
11322   case AA_Assigning:
11323   case AA_Initializing:
11324     // The destination type comes first.
11325     FirstType = DstType;
11326     SecondType = SrcType;
11327     break;
11328 
11329   case AA_Returning:
11330   case AA_Passing:
11331   case AA_Passing_CFAudited:
11332   case AA_Converting:
11333   case AA_Sending:
11334   case AA_Casting:
11335     // The source type comes first.
11336     FirstType = SrcType;
11337     SecondType = DstType;
11338     break;
11339   }
11340 
11341   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
11342   if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited)
11343     FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11344   else
11345     FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11346 
11347   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
11348   assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull());
11349   if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
11350     for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(),
11351          HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
11352       FDiag << *HI;
11353   } else {
11354     FDiag << Hint;
11355   }
11356   if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
11357 
11358   if (MayHaveFunctionDiff)
11359     HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType);
11360 
11361   Diag(Loc, FDiag);
11362   if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id &&
11363       PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition())
11364       Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id)
11365         << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName();
11366 
11367   if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy)
11368     NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression,
11369                               FirstType);
11370 
11371   if (CheckInferredResultType)
11372     EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
11373 
11374   if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer)
11375     EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType);
11376 
11377   if (Complained)
11378     *Complained = true;
11379   return isInvalid;
11380 }
11381 
11382 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11383                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result) {
11384   class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11385   public:
11386     void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11387       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR;
11388     }
11389   } Diagnoser;
11390 
11391   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser);
11392 }
11393 
11394 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11395                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result,
11396                                                  unsigned DiagID,
11397                                                  bool AllowFold) {
11398   class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11399     unsigned DiagID;
11400 
11401   public:
11402     IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID)
11403       : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { }
11404 
11405     void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11406       S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR;
11407     }
11408   } Diagnoser(DiagID);
11409 
11410   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold);
11411 }
11412 
11413 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11414                                             SourceRange SR) {
11415   S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
11416 }
11417 
11418 ExprResult
11419 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result,
11420                                       VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
11421                                       bool AllowFold) {
11422   SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart();
11423 
11424   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
11425     // C++11 [expr.const]p5:
11426     //   If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an
11427     //   integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall
11428     //   have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or
11429     //   unscoped enumeration type
11430     ExprResult Converted;
11431     class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser {
11432     public:
11433       CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent)
11434           : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false,
11435                                 Silent, true) {}
11436 
11437       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11438                                            QualType T) override {
11439         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T;
11440       }
11441 
11442       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(
11443           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11444         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T;
11445       }
11446 
11447       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(
11448           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11449         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy;
11450       }
11451 
11452       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(
11453           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11454         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11455                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11456       }
11457 
11458       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(
11459           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11460         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T;
11461       }
11462 
11463       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(
11464           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11465         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11466                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11467       }
11468 
11469       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(
11470           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11471         llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted");
11472       }
11473     } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress);
11474 
11475     Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E,
11476                                                     ConvertDiagnoser);
11477     if (Converted.isInvalid())
11478       return Converted;
11479     E = Converted.get();
11480     if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
11481       return ExprError();
11482   } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
11483     // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type.
11484     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
11485       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11486     return ExprError();
11487   }
11488 
11489   // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice
11490   // in the non-ICE case.
11491   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
11492     if (Result)
11493       *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context);
11494     return E;
11495   }
11496 
11497   Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
11498   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
11499   EvalResult.Diag = &Notes;
11500 
11501   // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's
11502   // not a constant expression as a side-effect.
11503   bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) &&
11504                 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects;
11505 
11506   // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression
11507   // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then
11508   // this is a constant expression.
11509   if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) {
11510     if (Result)
11511       *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11512     return E;
11513   }
11514 
11515   // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
11516   // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
11517   // redundant note.
11518   if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
11519         diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
11520     DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
11521     Notes.clear();
11522   }
11523 
11524   if (!Folded || !AllowFold) {
11525     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
11526       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11527       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11528         Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11529     }
11530 
11531     return ExprError();
11532   }
11533 
11534   Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11535   for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11536     Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11537 
11538   if (Result)
11539     *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11540   return E;
11541 }
11542 
11543 namespace {
11544   // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively
11545   // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated.
11546   class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> {
11547     typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform;
11548 
11549   public:
11550     TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { }
11551 
11552     // Make sure we redo semantic analysis
11553     bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
11554 
11555     // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly.
11556     // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general
11557     // fix to TreeTransform?
11558     StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) {
11559       S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr);
11560       return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S);
11561     }
11562 
11563     // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which
11564     // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming
11565     // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST.
11566     // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this
11567     // case?
11568     //
11569     // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls.
11570     ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
11571       if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) &&
11572           !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
11573         return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(),
11574                             diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
11575             << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
11576 
11577       return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E);
11578     }
11579 
11580     // Exception: filter out member pointer formation
11581     ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
11582       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType())
11583         return E;
11584 
11585       return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E);
11586     }
11587 
11588     ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) {
11589       // Lambdas never need to be transformed.
11590       return E;
11591     }
11592   };
11593 }
11594 
11595 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) {
11596   assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
11597          "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
11598   ExprEvalContexts.back().Context =
11599       ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context;
11600   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
11601     return E;
11602   return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E);
11603 }
11604 
11605 void
11606 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
11607                                       Decl *LambdaContextDecl,
11608                                       bool IsDecltype) {
11609   ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(),
11610                                 ExprNeedsCleanups, LambdaContextDecl,
11611                                 IsDecltype);
11612   ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
11613   if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty())
11614     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
11615 }
11616 
11617 void
11618 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
11619                                       ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
11620                                       bool IsDecltype) {
11621   Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl;
11622   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype);
11623 }
11624 
11625 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
11626   ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
11627   unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos;
11628 
11629   if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) {
11630     if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
11631       unsigned D;
11632       if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) {
11633         // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2:
11634         //   A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand
11635         //   (Clause 5).
11636         D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand;
11637       } else {
11638         // C++1y [expr.const]p2:
11639         //   A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the
11640         //   evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would
11641         //   evaluate [...] a lambda-expression.
11642         D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression;
11643       }
11644       for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas)
11645         Diag(L->getLocStart(), D);
11646     } else {
11647       // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred
11648       // during lambda expression creation.
11649       for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) {
11650         for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits())
11651           MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C);
11652       }
11653     }
11654   }
11655 
11656   // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
11657   // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
11658   // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
11659   // will never be constructed.
11660   if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
11661     ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects,
11662                              ExprCleanupObjects.end());
11663     ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
11664     CleanupVarDeclMarking();
11665     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
11666   // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
11667   } else {
11668     ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
11669     MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
11670                             Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end());
11671   }
11672 
11673   // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
11674   ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
11675 
11676   if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty())
11677     ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos;
11678   else
11679     assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the "
11680                             "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord");
11681 }
11682 
11683 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
11684   ExprCleanupObjects.erase(
11685          ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects,
11686          ExprCleanupObjects.end());
11687   ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
11688   MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
11689 }
11690 
11691 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) {
11692   if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
11693     return E;
11694   return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
11695 }
11696 
11697 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
11698   // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
11699   // an instantiation.
11700   if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext())
11701     return false;
11702 
11703   switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
11704     case Sema::Unevaluated:
11705     case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract:
11706       // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
11707       // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do
11708       // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's
11709       // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.)
11710       return false;
11711 
11712     case Sema::ConstantEvaluated:
11713     case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated:
11714       // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression
11715       // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly
11716       // define class members, and mark most declarations as used.
11717       return true;
11718 
11719     case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
11720       // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
11721       // containing expression is used.
11722       return false;
11723   }
11724   llvm_unreachable("Invalid context");
11725 }
11726 
11727 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
11728 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3)
11729 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func,
11730                                   bool OdrUse) {
11731   assert(Func && "No function?");
11732 
11733   Func->setReferenced();
11734 
11735   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3:
11736   //   A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is
11737   //   odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a
11738   //   set of overloaded functions [...].
11739   //
11740   // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we
11741   // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already
11742   // marked the function as used.
11743   if (Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) ||
11744       !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) {
11745     // C++11 [temp.inst]p3:
11746     //   Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly
11747     //   instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template
11748     //   specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is
11749     //   referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist.
11750     //
11751     // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context
11752     // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced.
11753     //
11754     // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is
11755     // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a
11756     // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we
11757     // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a
11758     // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a
11759     // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list),
11760     // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition.
11761     //
11762     // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They
11763     // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they
11764     // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts.
11765     // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are
11766     // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would
11767     // fail.
11768     if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody())
11769       return;
11770     CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func);
11771     if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided()))
11772       return;
11773   }
11774 
11775   // Note that this declaration has been used.
11776   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
11777     Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl());
11778     if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) {
11779       if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
11780         if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
11781           return;
11782         DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
11783       } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
11784         DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
11785       } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
11786         DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
11787       }
11788     } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) {
11789       DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
11790     }
11791   } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
11792                  dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
11793     Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl());
11794     if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted())
11795       DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
11796     if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
11797       MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
11798   } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) {
11799     if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
11800         MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
11801       MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
11802       if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) {
11803         if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
11804           DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
11805         else
11806           DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
11807       }
11808     } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) &&
11809                MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) {
11810       CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
11811           cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
11812       if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion())
11813         DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
11814       else
11815         DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
11816     } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
11817       MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
11818   }
11819 
11820   // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
11821   // FIXME: Is this really right?
11822   if (CurContext == Func) return;
11823 
11824   // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is
11825   // used: CodeGen will need it.
11826   const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11827   if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()))
11828     ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
11829 
11830   if (!OdrUse) return;
11831 
11832   // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
11833   // class templates.
11834   if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
11835     bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
11836     SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
11837     if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
11838                               = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
11839       if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
11840         SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
11841       else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
11842                  == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
11843         AlreadyInstantiated = true;
11844         PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
11845       }
11846     } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
11847                                 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
11848       if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
11849         MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
11850       else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
11851                  == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
11852         AlreadyInstantiated = true;
11853         PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
11854       }
11855     }
11856 
11857     if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) {
11858       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) &&
11859           cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() &&
11860           ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size())
11861         PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(
11862             std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
11863       else if (Func->isConstexpr())
11864         // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the
11865         // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a
11866         // call to such a function.
11867         InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func);
11868       else {
11869         PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func,
11870                                                        PointOfInstantiation));
11871         // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated.
11872         Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func);
11873       }
11874     }
11875   } else {
11876     // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
11877     for (auto i : Func->redecls()) {
11878       if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
11879         MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i);
11880     }
11881   }
11882 
11883   // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
11884   if (!Func->isDefined()) {
11885     if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func))
11886       UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
11887     else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() &&
11888              (LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !LangOpts.GNUInline) &&
11889              !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
11890       UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
11891   }
11892 
11893   // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and
11894   // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with
11895   // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file
11896   // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at
11897   // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant
11898   // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used.
11899   for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) {
11900     F->markUsed(Context);
11901     if (F == Func)
11902       break;
11903   }
11904 }
11905 
11906 static void
11907 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
11908                                    VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) {
11909   DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext();
11910 
11911   //  If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
11912   //  we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
11913   //  the next.
11914   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) &&
11915       isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC))
11916     return;
11917 
11918   // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code
11919   // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of
11920   // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later.
11921   //
11922   // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this
11923   // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound
11924   // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious.
11925   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
11926     return;
11927 
11928   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) &&
11929       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) {
11930     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda)
11931       << var->getIdentifier();
11932   } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) {
11933     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
11934       << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName();
11935   } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) {
11936     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block)
11937       << var->getIdentifier();
11938   } else {
11939     // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be
11940     // declared?
11941     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context)
11942       << var->getIdentifier();
11943   }
11944 
11945   S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
11946       << var->getIdentifier();
11947 
11948   // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents
11949   // capture.
11950 }
11951 
11952 
11953 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
11954                                       bool &SubCapturesAreNested,
11955                                       QualType &CaptureType,
11956                                       QualType &DeclRefType) {
11957    // Check whether we've already captured it.
11958   if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) {
11959     // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested.
11960     SubCapturesAreNested = true;
11961 
11962     // Retrieve the capture type for this variable.
11963     CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType();
11964 
11965     // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable.
11966     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
11967 
11968     const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var);
11969     if (Cap.isCopyCapture() &&
11970         !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable))
11971       DeclRefType.addConst();
11972     return true;
11973   }
11974   return false;
11975 }
11976 
11977 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
11978 // capture; other scopes don't work.
11979 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var,
11980                                  SourceLocation Loc,
11981                                  const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
11982   if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC))
11983     return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
11984   else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
11985     if (Diagnose)
11986        diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC);
11987   }
11988   return nullptr;
11989 }
11990 
11991 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
11992 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
11993 // so check for eligibility.
11994 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
11995                                  SourceLocation Loc,
11996                                  const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
11997 
11998   bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI);
11999   bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12000 
12001   // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables
12002   // (e.g. anonymous unions).
12003   // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm
12004   // assuming that's the intent.
12005   if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) {
12006     if (Diagnose) {
12007       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var);
12008       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
12009     }
12010     return false;
12011   }
12012 
12013   // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with.
12014   if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) {
12015     if (Diagnose) {
12016       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
12017       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12018         << Var->getDeclName();
12019     }
12020     return false;
12021   }
12022   // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too.
12023   // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct.
12024   if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12025     if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
12026       if (Diagnose) {
12027         if (IsBlock)
12028           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type);
12029         else
12030           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type)
12031             << Var->getDeclName();
12032         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12033           << Var->getDeclName();
12034       }
12035       return false;
12036     }
12037   }
12038   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12039   // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block
12040   // variables; they don't support the expected semantics.
12041   if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) {
12042     if (Diagnose) {
12043       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable)
12044         << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda;
12045       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12046         << Var->getDeclName();
12047     }
12048     return false;
12049   }
12050 
12051   return true;
12052 }
12053 
12054 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful.
12055 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var,
12056                                  SourceLocation Loc,
12057                                  const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12058                                  QualType &CaptureType,
12059                                  QualType &DeclRefType,
12060                                  const bool Nested,
12061                                  Sema &S) {
12062   Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12063   bool ByRef = false;
12064 
12065   // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays.
12066   if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) {
12067     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12068       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
12069       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12070       << Var->getDeclName();
12071     }
12072     return false;
12073   }
12074 
12075   // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12076   if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12077     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12078       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture)
12079         << /*block*/ 0;
12080       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12081         << Var->getDeclName();
12082     }
12083     return false;
12084   }
12085   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12086   if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) {
12087     // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or
12088     // declaration reference types.
12089     ByRef = true;
12090   } else {
12091     // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'.
12092     CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst();
12093     DeclRefType = CaptureType;
12094 
12095     if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) {
12096       if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12097         // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
12098         // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
12099         // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
12100         // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
12101         // actually requires the destructor.
12102         if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12103           S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record);
12104 
12105         // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy
12106         // full-expression.
12107         EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated);
12108 
12109         // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
12110         // the stack requires a const copy constructor.  This is not true
12111         // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
12112         Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested,
12113                                                   DeclRefType.withConst(),
12114                                                   VK_LValue, Loc);
12115 
12116         ExprResult Result
12117           = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
12118               InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(),
12119                                                   CaptureType, false),
12120               Loc, DeclRef);
12121 
12122         // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
12123         // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor.  Recover from
12124         // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
12125         if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
12126             !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor()
12127                 ->isTrivial()) {
12128           Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result);
12129           CopyExpr = Result.get();
12130         }
12131       }
12132     }
12133   }
12134 
12135   // Actually capture the variable.
12136   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12137     BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc,
12138                     SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12139 
12140   return true;
12141 
12142 }
12143 
12144 
12145 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region.
12146 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI,
12147                                     VarDecl *Var,
12148                                     SourceLocation Loc,
12149                                     const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12150                                     QualType &CaptureType,
12151                                     QualType &DeclRefType,
12152                                     const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12153                                     Sema &S) {
12154 
12155   // By default, capture variables by reference.
12156   bool ByRef = true;
12157   // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below).
12158   CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12159   Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12160   if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12161     // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured
12162     // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression
12163     // evaluation will be needed.
12164     RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl;
12165 
12166     FieldDecl *Field
12167       = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType,
12168                           S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc),
12169                           nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12170     Field->setImplicit(true);
12171     Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12172     RD->addDecl(Field);
12173 
12174     CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12175                                             DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc);
12176     Var->setReferenced(true);
12177     Var->markUsed(S.Context);
12178   }
12179 
12180   // Actually capture the variable.
12181   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12182     RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc,
12183                     SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12184 
12185 
12186   return true;
12187 }
12188 
12189 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable
12190 ///  being captured.  Handle Array captures.
12191 static ExprResult addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S,
12192                                  LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
12193                                   VarDecl *Var, QualType FieldType,
12194                                   QualType DeclRefType,
12195                                   SourceLocation Loc,
12196                                   bool RefersToCapturedVariable) {
12197   CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda;
12198 
12199   // Build the non-static data member.
12200   FieldDecl *Field
12201     = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType,
12202                         S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc),
12203                         nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12204   Field->setImplicit(true);
12205   Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12206   Lambda->addDecl(Field);
12207 
12208   // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p21:
12209   //   When the lambda-expression is evaluated, the entities that
12210   //   are captured by copy are used to direct-initialize each
12211   //   corresponding non-static data member of the resulting closure
12212   //   object. (For array members, the array elements are
12213   //   direct-initialized in increasing subscript order.) These
12214   //   initializations are performed in the (unspecified) order in
12215   //   which the non-static data members are declared.
12216 
12217   // Introduce a new evaluation context for the initialization, so
12218   // that temporaries introduced as part of the capture are retained
12219   // to be re-"exported" from the lambda expression itself.
12220   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated);
12221 
12222   // C++ [expr.prim.labda]p12:
12223   //   An entity captured by a lambda-expression is odr-used (3.2) in
12224   //   the scope containing the lambda-expression.
12225   Expr *Ref = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12226                                           DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc);
12227   Var->setReferenced(true);
12228   Var->markUsed(S.Context);
12229 
12230   // When the field has array type, create index variables for each
12231   // dimension of the array. We use these index variables to subscript
12232   // the source array, and other clients (e.g., CodeGen) will perform
12233   // the necessary iteration with these index variables.
12234   SmallVector<VarDecl *, 4> IndexVariables;
12235   QualType BaseType = FieldType;
12236   QualType SizeType = S.Context.getSizeType();
12237   LSI->ArrayIndexStarts.push_back(LSI->ArrayIndexVars.size());
12238   while (const ConstantArrayType *Array
12239                         = S.Context.getAsConstantArrayType(BaseType)) {
12240     // Create the iteration variable for this array index.
12241     IdentifierInfo *IterationVarName = nullptr;
12242     {
12243       SmallString<8> Str;
12244       llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
12245       OS << "__i" << IndexVariables.size();
12246       IterationVarName = &S.Context.Idents.get(OS.str());
12247     }
12248     VarDecl *IterationVar
12249       = VarDecl::Create(S.Context, S.CurContext, Loc, Loc,
12250                         IterationVarName, SizeType,
12251                         S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SizeType, Loc),
12252                         SC_None);
12253     IndexVariables.push_back(IterationVar);
12254     LSI->ArrayIndexVars.push_back(IterationVar);
12255 
12256     // Create a reference to the iteration variable.
12257     ExprResult IterationVarRef
12258       = S.BuildDeclRefExpr(IterationVar, SizeType, VK_LValue, Loc);
12259     assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() &&
12260            "Reference to invented variable cannot fail!");
12261     IterationVarRef = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(IterationVarRef.get());
12262     assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() &&
12263            "Conversion of invented variable cannot fail!");
12264 
12265     // Subscript the array with this iteration variable.
12266     ExprResult Subscript = S.CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(
12267                              Ref, Loc, IterationVarRef.get(), Loc);
12268     if (Subscript.isInvalid()) {
12269       S.CleanupVarDeclMarking();
12270       S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
12271       return ExprError();
12272     }
12273 
12274     Ref = Subscript.get();
12275     BaseType = Array->getElementType();
12276   }
12277 
12278   // Construct the entity that we will be initializing. For an array, this
12279   // will be first element in the array, which may require several levels
12280   // of array-subscript entities.
12281   SmallVector<InitializedEntity, 4> Entities;
12282   Entities.reserve(1 + IndexVariables.size());
12283   Entities.push_back(
12284     InitializedEntity::InitializeLambdaCapture(Var->getIdentifier(),
12285         Field->getType(), Loc));
12286   for (unsigned I = 0, N = IndexVariables.size(); I != N; ++I)
12287     Entities.push_back(InitializedEntity::InitializeElement(S.Context,
12288                                                             0,
12289                                                             Entities.back()));
12290 
12291   InitializationKind InitKind
12292     = InitializationKind::CreateDirect(Loc, Loc, Loc);
12293   InitializationSequence Init(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref);
12294   ExprResult Result(true);
12295   if (!Init.Diagnose(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref))
12296     Result = Init.Perform(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref);
12297 
12298   // If this initialization requires any cleanups (e.g., due to a
12299   // default argument to a copy constructor), note that for the
12300   // lambda.
12301   if (S.ExprNeedsCleanups)
12302     LSI->ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
12303 
12304   // Exit the expression evaluation context used for the capture.
12305   S.CleanupVarDeclMarking();
12306   S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
12307   return Result;
12308 }
12309 
12310 
12311 
12312 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda.
12313 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
12314                             VarDecl *Var,
12315                             SourceLocation Loc,
12316                             const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12317                             QualType &CaptureType,
12318                             QualType &DeclRefType,
12319                             const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12320                             const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind,
12321                             SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
12322                             const bool IsTopScope,
12323                             Sema &S) {
12324 
12325   // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value.
12326   bool ByRef = false;
12327   if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) {
12328     ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef);
12329   } else {
12330     ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref);
12331   }
12332 
12333   // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable.
12334   if (ByRef) {
12335     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15:
12336     //   An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or
12337     //   explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is
12338     //   unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data
12339     //   members are declared in the closure type for entities
12340     //   captured by reference.
12341     //
12342     // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference
12343     // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears
12344     // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will
12345     // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and
12346     // easily defensible position.
12347     CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12348   } else {
12349     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14:
12350     //   For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static
12351     //   data member is declared in the closure type. The
12352     //   declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type
12353     //   of such a data member is the type of the corresponding
12354     //   captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an
12355     //   object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the
12356     //   captured entity is a reference to a function, the
12357     //   corresponding data member is also a reference to a
12358     //   function. - end note ]
12359     if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){
12360       if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
12361         CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType();
12362     }
12363 
12364     // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12365     if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12366       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12367         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1;
12368         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12369           << Var->getDeclName();
12370       }
12371       return false;
12372     }
12373 
12374     // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type.
12375     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12376       if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() &&
12377           S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType,
12378                                 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type,
12379                                 Var->getDeclName()))
12380         return false;
12381 
12382       if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType,
12383                                    diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type))
12384         return false;
12385     }
12386   }
12387 
12388   // Capture this variable in the lambda.
12389   Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12390   if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12391     ExprResult Result = addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var,
12392                                         CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc,
12393                                         RefersToCapturedVariable);
12394     if (!Result.isInvalid())
12395       CopyExpr = Result.get();
12396   }
12397 
12398   // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable.
12399   if (ByRef)
12400     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12401   else {
12402     // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5:
12403     //   The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline
12404     //   function call operator [...]. This function call operator is
12405     //   declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression’s
12406     //   parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable.
12407     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12408     if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType())
12409       DeclRefType.addConst();
12410   }
12411 
12412   // Add the capture.
12413   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12414     LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12415                     Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12416 
12417   return true;
12418 }
12419 
12420 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc,
12421                               TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
12422                               bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12423                               QualType &CaptureType,
12424                               QualType &DeclRefType,
12425 						                const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12426   bool Nested = Var->isInitCapture();
12427 
12428   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
12429   const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12430       ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12431   // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the
12432   // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12433   if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12434     unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12435     while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) {
12436       DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
12437       --FSIndex;
12438     }
12439   }
12440 
12441 
12442   // If the variable is declared in the current context (and is not an
12443   // init-capture), there is no need to capture it.
12444   if (!Nested && Var->getDeclContext() == DC) return true;
12445 
12446   // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this
12447   // variable.
12448   bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage();
12449   if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var)))
12450     return true;
12451 
12452   // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable,
12453   // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when
12454   // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing
12455   // capture of that variable.  We start from the innermost capturing-entity
12456   // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities
12457   // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s
12458   // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured
12459   // the variable.
12460   CaptureType = Var->getType();
12461   DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12462   bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit);
12463   unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex;
12464   do {
12465     // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
12466     // capture; other scopes don't work.
12467     DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var,
12468                                                               ExprLoc,
12469                                                               BuildAndDiagnose,
12470                                                               *this);
12471     // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have*
12472     // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in
12473     // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc.
12474     if (!ParentDC) {
12475       if (IsGlobal) {
12476         FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1;
12477         break;
12478       }
12479       return true;
12480     }
12481 
12482     FunctionScopeInfo  *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex];
12483     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI);
12484 
12485 
12486     // Check whether we've already captured it.
12487     if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType,
12488                                              DeclRefType))
12489       break;
12490     // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body,
12491     // we do not want to capture new variables.  What was captured
12492     // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing
12493     // should be used.
12494     if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) {
12495       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12496         LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12497         if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) {
12498           Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
12499           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12500              << Var->getDeclName();
12501           Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
12502         } else
12503           diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC);
12504       }
12505       return true;
12506     }
12507     // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
12508     // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
12509     // so check for eligibility.
12510     if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this))
12511        return true;
12512 
12513     // Try to capture variable-length arrays types.
12514     if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
12515       // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA
12516       // expressions.
12517       QualType QTy = Var->getType();
12518       if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12519         QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
12520       do {
12521         const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr();
12522         switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) {
12523 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
12524 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12525 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
12526 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
12527 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12528 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
12529           QTy = QualType();
12530           break;
12531         // These types are never variably-modified.
12532         case Type::Builtin:
12533         case Type::Complex:
12534         case Type::Vector:
12535         case Type::ExtVector:
12536         case Type::Record:
12537         case Type::Enum:
12538         case Type::Elaborated:
12539         case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
12540         case Type::ObjCObject:
12541         case Type::ObjCInterface:
12542         case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
12543           llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!");
12544         case Type::Adjusted:
12545           QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType();
12546           break;
12547         case Type::Decayed:
12548           QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12549           break;
12550         case Type::Pointer:
12551           QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12552           break;
12553         case Type::BlockPointer:
12554           QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12555           break;
12556         case Type::LValueReference:
12557         case Type::RValueReference:
12558           QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12559           break;
12560         case Type::MemberPointer:
12561           QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12562           break;
12563         case Type::ConstantArray:
12564         case Type::IncompleteArray:
12565           // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12566           QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType();
12567           break;
12568         case Type::VariableArray: {
12569           // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12570           const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty);
12571 
12572           // Unknown size indication requires no size computation.
12573           // Otherwise, evaluate and record it.
12574           if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) {
12575             if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) {
12576               RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr;
12577               if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12578                 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda;
12579               } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12580                 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl;
12581               }
12582               if (CapRecord) {
12583                 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc();
12584                 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
12585                 // Build the non-static data member.
12586                 auto Field = FieldDecl::Create(
12587                     Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc,
12588                     /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr,
12589                     /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false,
12590                     /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit);
12591                 Field->setImplicit(true);
12592                 Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12593                 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT);
12594                 CapRecord->addDecl(Field);
12595 
12596                 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType);
12597               }
12598             }
12599           }
12600           QTy = VAT->getElementType();
12601           break;
12602         }
12603         case Type::FunctionProto:
12604         case Type::FunctionNoProto:
12605           QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType();
12606           break;
12607         case Type::Paren:
12608         case Type::TypeOf:
12609         case Type::UnaryTransform:
12610         case Type::Attributed:
12611         case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
12612         case Type::PackExpansion:
12613           // Keep walking after single level desugaring.
12614           QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext());
12615           break;
12616         case Type::Typedef:
12617           QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar();
12618           break;
12619         case Type::Decltype:
12620           QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar();
12621           break;
12622         case Type::Auto:
12623           QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType();
12624           break;
12625         case Type::TypeOfExpr:
12626           QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType();
12627           break;
12628         case Type::Atomic:
12629           QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType();
12630           break;
12631         }
12632       } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType());
12633     }
12634 
12635     if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) {
12636       // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture
12637       // so cannot capture this variable.
12638       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12639         Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
12640         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12641           << Var->getDeclName();
12642         Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(),
12643              diag::note_lambda_decl);
12644         // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly
12645         // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we
12646         // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because
12647         // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later.  This would purely be done
12648         // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable
12649         // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured
12650         // explicitly.  Suggestion:
12651         //  - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit
12652         //    at the function head
12653         //  - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda
12654         //  - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable.
12655       }
12656       return true;
12657     }
12658 
12659     FunctionScopesIndex--;
12660     DC = ParentDC;
12661     Explicit = false;
12662   } while (!Var->getDeclContext()->Equals(DC));
12663 
12664   // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda)
12665   // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific
12666   // requirements, and adding captures if requested.
12667   // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing
12668   // at the lambda nested within that one.
12669   for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N;
12670        ++I) {
12671     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]);
12672 
12673     if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12674       if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12675                           BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12676                           DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
12677         return true;
12678       Nested = true;
12679     } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12680       if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12681                                    BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12682                                    DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
12683         return true;
12684       Nested = true;
12685     } else {
12686       LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12687       if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12688                            BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12689                            DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
12690                             /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this))
12691         return true;
12692       Nested = true;
12693     }
12694   }
12695   return false;
12696 }
12697 
12698 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
12699                               TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) {
12700   QualType CaptureType;
12701   QualType DeclRefType;
12702   return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
12703                             /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType,
12704                             DeclRefType, nullptr);
12705 }
12706 
12707 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
12708   QualType CaptureType;
12709   QualType DeclRefType;
12710   return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
12711                              /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
12712                              DeclRefType, nullptr);
12713 }
12714 
12715 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
12716   QualType CaptureType;
12717   QualType DeclRefType;
12718 
12719   // Determine whether we can capture this variable.
12720   if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
12721                          /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
12722                          DeclRefType, nullptr))
12723     return QualType();
12724 
12725   return DeclRefType;
12726 }
12727 
12728 
12729 
12730 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent,
12731 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant
12732 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or
12733 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression.
12734 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var,
12735     ASTContext &Context) {
12736 
12737   if (Var->getType()->isDependentType())
12738     return false;
12739   const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr;
12740   Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD);
12741   if (!DefVD)
12742     return false;
12743   EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt();
12744   Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value);
12745   if (Init->isValueDependent())
12746     return false;
12747   return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context);
12748 }
12749 
12750 
12751 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) {
12752   // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is
12753   // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a
12754   // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
12755   // is immediately applied."  This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue
12756   // conversion part.
12757   MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens());
12758 
12759   // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers
12760   // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as
12761   // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that
12762   // variable.
12763   if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) {
12764     Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens();
12765     VarDecl *Var = nullptr;
12766     if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr))
12767       Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl());
12768     else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr))
12769       Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
12770 
12771     if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context))
12772       LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr);
12773   }
12774 }
12775 
12776 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) {
12777   Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res);
12778 
12779   if (!Res.isUsable())
12780     return Res;
12781 
12782   // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay
12783   // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the
12784   // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion.  In the one case where this doesn't happen
12785   // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway.
12786   UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get());
12787   return Res;
12788 }
12789 
12790 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() {
12791   for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
12792                                         e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end();
12793        i != e; ++i) {
12794     VarDecl *Var;
12795     SourceLocation Loc;
12796     if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) {
12797       Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
12798       Loc = DRE->getLocation();
12799     } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) {
12800       Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
12801       Loc = ME->getMemberLoc();
12802     } else {
12803       llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression");
12804     }
12805 
12806     MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this,
12807                        /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr);
12808   }
12809 
12810   MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
12811 }
12812 
12813 
12814 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
12815                                     VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) {
12816   assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) &&
12817          "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced");
12818   Var->setReferenced();
12819 
12820   TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
12821   bool MarkODRUsed = true;
12822 
12823   // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and
12824   // does not trigger instantiation.
12825   if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) {
12826     if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
12827       return;
12828 
12829     // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an
12830     // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing
12831     // scope, add a potential capture.
12832     //
12833     // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default
12834     // arguments, where local variables can't be used.
12835     const bool RefersToEnclosingScope =
12836         (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() &&
12837          Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage());
12838     if (RefersToEnclosingScope) {
12839       if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) {
12840         // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so
12841         // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any
12842         // lvalue-to-rvalue
12843         // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use.
12844         // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed
12845         // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking
12846         // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant
12847         // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used).
12848         assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression.");
12849         if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() ||
12850             !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context))
12851           LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens());
12852       }
12853     }
12854 
12855     if (!isTemplateInstantiation(TSK))
12856     	return;
12857 
12858     // Instantiate, but do not mark as odr-used, variable templates.
12859     MarkODRUsed = false;
12860   }
12861 
12862   VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
12863       dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var);
12864   assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) &&
12865          "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization.");
12866 
12867   // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member
12868   // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay
12869   // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used
12870   // in a constant expression.
12871   if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) {
12872     bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation;
12873 
12874     if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) {
12875       if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) {
12876         // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners.
12877         if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener())
12878           L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var);
12879       } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
12880         // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need
12881         // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU.
12882         TryInstantiating = false;
12883     }
12884 
12885     if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
12886       Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc);
12887 
12888     if (TryInstantiating) {
12889       SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation();
12890       bool InstantiationDependent = false;
12891       bool IsNonDependent =
12892           VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments(
12893                         VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent)
12894                   : true;
12895 
12896       // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent.
12897       if (IsNonDependent) {
12898         if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) {
12899           // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a
12900           // constant expression.
12901           SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var);
12902         } else {
12903           SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
12904               .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
12905         }
12906       }
12907     }
12908   }
12909 
12910   if(!MarkODRUsed) return;
12911 
12912   // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies
12913   // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if
12914   // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
12915   // is immediately applied."  We check the first part here, and
12916   // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part.
12917   // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in
12918   // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second
12919   // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects.
12920   if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) {
12921     // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be
12922     // odr-used, so simply ignore it.
12923     if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType())
12924       SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E);
12925   } else
12926     MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef,
12927                        /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr);
12928 }
12929 
12930 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
12931 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3).  Note that this should not be
12932 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl.
12933 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) {
12934   DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr);
12935 }
12936 
12937 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
12938                                Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) {
12939   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
12940     DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E);
12941     return;
12942   }
12943 
12944   SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse);
12945 
12946   // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the
12947   // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call.
12948   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
12949   if (!ME)
12950     return;
12951   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
12952   if (!MD)
12953     return;
12954   // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call.
12955   bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && !ME->hasQualifier();
12956   if (!IsVirtualCall)
12957     return;
12958   const Expr *Base = ME->getBase();
12959   const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType();
12960   if (!MostDerivedClassDecl)
12961     return;
12962   CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl);
12963   if (!DM || DM->isPure())
12964     return;
12965   SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse);
12966 }
12967 
12968 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
12969 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) {
12970   // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed.
12971   // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even
12972   // if it's a qualified reference.
12973   bool OdrUse = true;
12974   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl()))
12975     if (Method->isVirtual())
12976       OdrUse = false;
12977   MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse);
12978 }
12979 
12980 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
12981 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) {
12982   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2:
12983   //   A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated
12984   //   expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by
12985   //   overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated
12986   //   expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its
12987   //   name is not explicitly qualified.
12988   bool OdrUse = true;
12989   if (!E->hasQualifier()) {
12990     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()))
12991       if (Method->isPure())
12992         OdrUse = false;
12993   }
12994   SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ?
12995                             E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart();
12996   MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse);
12997 }
12998 
12999 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration.  It
13000 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for
13001 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a
13002 /// normal expression which refers to a variable.
13003 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) {
13004   if (OdrUse) {
13005     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
13006       MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD);
13007       return;
13008     }
13009   }
13010   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
13011     MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, OdrUse);
13012     return;
13013   }
13014   D->setReferenced();
13015 }
13016 
13017 namespace {
13018   // Mark all of the declarations referenced
13019   // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
13020   // of when we're entering
13021   class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
13022     Sema &S;
13023     SourceLocation Loc;
13024 
13025   public:
13026     typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
13027 
13028     MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
13029 
13030     bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
13031     bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
13032   };
13033 }
13034 
13035 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
13036     const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
13037   if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
13038     if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl())
13039       S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true);
13040   }
13041 
13042   return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
13043 }
13044 
13045 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
13046   if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
13047                   = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
13048     const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
13049     return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
13050   }
13051 
13052   return true;
13053 }
13054 
13055 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
13056   MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
13057   Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
13058 }
13059 
13060 namespace {
13061   /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
13062   /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13063   class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
13064     Sema &S;
13065     bool SkipLocalVariables;
13066 
13067   public:
13068     typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
13069 
13070     EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables)
13071       : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { }
13072 
13073     void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13074       // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't.
13075       if (SkipLocalVariables) {
13076         if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl()))
13077           if (VD->hasLocalStorage())
13078             return;
13079       }
13080 
13081       S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
13082     }
13083 
13084     void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13085       S.MarkMemberReferenced(E);
13086       Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
13087     }
13088 
13089     void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) {
13090       S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13091             const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor()));
13092       Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13093     }
13094 
13095     void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
13096       if (E->getOperatorNew())
13097         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
13098       if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13099         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13100       Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
13101     }
13102 
13103     void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
13104       if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13105         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13106       QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
13107       if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13108         CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
13109         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13110                                     S.LookupDestructor(Record));
13111       }
13112 
13113       Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
13114     }
13115 
13116     void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
13117       S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
13118       Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
13119     }
13120 
13121     void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
13122       Visit(E->getExpr());
13123     }
13124 
13125     void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
13126       Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
13127 
13128       if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
13129         S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr());
13130     }
13131   };
13132 }
13133 
13134 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
13135 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13136 ///
13137 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as
13138 /// 'referenced'.
13139 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E,
13140                                             bool SkipLocalVariables) {
13141   EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E);
13142 }
13143 
13144 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
13145 /// of the program being compiled.
13146 ///
13147 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
13148 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
13149 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
13150 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
13151 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
13152 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
13153 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
13154 /// later.
13155 ///
13156 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
13157 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
13158 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
13159 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
13160 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
13161                                const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
13162   switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
13163   case Unevaluated:
13164   case UnevaluatedAbstract:
13165     // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
13166     break;
13167 
13168   case ConstantEvaluated:
13169     // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation.
13170     break;
13171 
13172   case PotentiallyEvaluated:
13173   case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
13174     if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
13175       FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.
13176         push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement));
13177     }
13178     else
13179       Diag(Loc, PD);
13180 
13181     return true;
13182   }
13183 
13184   return false;
13185 }
13186 
13187 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
13188                                CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
13189   if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
13190     return false;
13191 
13192   // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return
13193   // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call.
13194   if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) {
13195     ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE);
13196     return false;
13197   }
13198 
13199   class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
13200     FunctionDecl *FD;
13201     CallExpr *CE;
13202 
13203   public:
13204     CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE)
13205       : FD(FD), CE(CE) { }
13206 
13207     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
13208       if (!FD) {
13209         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
13210           << T << CE->getSourceRange();
13211         return;
13212       }
13213 
13214       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
13215         << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T;
13216       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
13217           << FD->getDeclName();
13218     }
13219   } Diagnoser(FD, CE);
13220 
13221   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser))
13222     return true;
13223 
13224   return false;
13225 }
13226 
13227 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
13228 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
13229 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
13230   SourceLocation Loc;
13231 
13232   unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
13233   bool IsOrAssign = false;
13234 
13235   if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
13236     if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
13237       return;
13238 
13239     IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
13240 
13241     // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
13242     if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
13243           = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
13244       Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
13245 
13246       // self = [<foo> init...]
13247       if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init)
13248         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13249 
13250       // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
13251       else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
13252         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13253     }
13254 
13255     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13256   } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
13257     if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
13258       return;
13259 
13260     IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
13261     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13262   } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
13263     return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm());
13264   else {
13265     // Not an assignment.
13266     return;
13267   }
13268 
13269   Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
13270 
13271   SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart();
13272   SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
13273   Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
13274         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
13275         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
13276 
13277   if (IsOrAssign)
13278     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
13279       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
13280   else
13281     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
13282       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
13283 }
13284 
13285 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
13286 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
13287 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
13288   // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
13289   SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart();
13290   if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
13291     return;
13292   // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
13293   if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
13294     return;
13295 
13296   Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
13297 
13298   if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
13299     if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
13300         opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
13301                                                            == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
13302       SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
13303 
13304       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
13305       SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange();
13306       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
13307         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin())
13308         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd());
13309       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
13310         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
13311     }
13312 }
13313 
13314 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
13315   DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
13316   if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
13317     DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
13318 
13319   ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
13320   if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13321   E = result.get();
13322 
13323   if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
13324     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13325       return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4
13326 
13327     ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
13328     if (ERes.isInvalid())
13329       return ExprError();
13330     E = ERes.get();
13331 
13332     QualType T = E->getType();
13333     if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
13334       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
13335         << T << E->getSourceRange();
13336       return ExprError();
13337     }
13338     CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc);
13339   }
13340 
13341   return E;
13342 }
13343 
13344 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
13345                                        Expr *SubExpr) {
13346   if (!SubExpr)
13347     return ExprError();
13348 
13349   return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc);
13350 }
13351 
13352 namespace {
13353   /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
13354   /// to have an appropriate type.
13355   struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
13356     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
13357 
13358     Sema &S;
13359 
13360     RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
13361 
13362     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13363       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13364     }
13365 
13366     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13367       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
13368         << E->getSourceRange();
13369       return ExprError();
13370     }
13371 
13372     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13373     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
13374     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13375       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13376       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13377 
13378       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13379       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13380       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13381       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13382       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13383       return E;
13384     }
13385 
13386     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13387       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13388     }
13389 
13390     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13391       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13392     }
13393 
13394     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13395       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13396       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13397 
13398       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13399       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13400       E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
13401       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13402       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13403       return E;
13404     }
13405 
13406     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
13407       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
13408 
13409       E->setType(VD->getType());
13410 
13411       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13412       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
13413           !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
13414             cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
13415         E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
13416 
13417       return E;
13418     }
13419 
13420     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13421       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13422     }
13423 
13424     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13425       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13426     }
13427   };
13428 }
13429 
13430 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
13431 /// to have a function type.
13432 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
13433   ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
13434   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13435   return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get());
13436 }
13437 
13438 namespace {
13439   /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
13440   /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
13441   /// expression.  Strict preservation of the original source
13442   /// structure is not a goal.
13443   struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
13444     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
13445 
13446     Sema &S;
13447 
13448     /// The current destination type.
13449     QualType DestType;
13450 
13451     RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
13452       : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
13453 
13454     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13455       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13456     }
13457 
13458     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13459       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
13460         << E->getSourceRange();
13461       return ExprError();
13462     }
13463 
13464     ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
13465     ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
13466 
13467     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13468     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
13469     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13470       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13471       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13472       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13473       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13474       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13475       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13476       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13477       return E;
13478     }
13479 
13480     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13481       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13482     }
13483 
13484     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13485       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13486     }
13487 
13488     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13489       const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
13490       if (!Ptr) {
13491         S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
13492           << E->getSourceRange();
13493         return ExprError();
13494       }
13495       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13496       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13497       E->setType(DestType);
13498 
13499       // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
13500       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13501       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13502       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13503       E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get());
13504       return E;
13505     }
13506 
13507     ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
13508 
13509     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
13510 
13511     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13512       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13513     }
13514 
13515     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13516       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13517     }
13518   };
13519 }
13520 
13521 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
13522 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
13523   Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
13524 
13525   enum FnKind {
13526     FK_MemberFunction,
13527     FK_FunctionPointer,
13528     FK_BlockPointer
13529   };
13530 
13531   FnKind Kind;
13532   QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
13533   if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
13534     assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
13535     Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
13536     CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
13537   } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
13538     CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13539     Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
13540   } else {
13541     CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
13542     Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
13543   }
13544   const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
13545 
13546   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
13547   if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13548     unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
13549     if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
13550       diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
13551 
13552     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
13553       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
13554     return ExprError();
13555   }
13556 
13557   // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
13558   E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
13559   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
13560   assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13561 
13562   // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
13563   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
13564   if (Proto) {
13565     // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when
13566     // it has no idea what a function's signature is.
13567     //
13568     // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R
13569     // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++
13570     // would foul up all sorts of assumptions.  However, we cannot
13571     // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we
13572     // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see
13573     // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic.
13574     // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to
13575     // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype
13576     // "A foo(B,C,D,...);".  The only known exception is with the
13577     // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl
13578     // regardless of its normal CC.  Therefore we change the parameter
13579     // types to match the types of the arguments.
13580     //
13581     // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the
13582     // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST.
13583 
13584     ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes();
13585     SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
13586     if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case
13587       ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs());
13588       for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) {
13589         Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i);
13590         QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
13591         if (E->isLValue()) {
13592           ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13593         } else if (E->isXValue()) {
13594           ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13595         }
13596         ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType);
13597       }
13598       ParamTypes = ArgTypes;
13599     }
13600     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes,
13601                                          Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
13602   } else {
13603     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
13604                                                 FnType->getExtInfo());
13605   }
13606 
13607   // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
13608   switch (Kind) {
13609   case FK_MemberFunction:
13610     // Nothing to do.
13611     break;
13612 
13613   case FK_FunctionPointer:
13614     DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
13615     break;
13616 
13617   case FK_BlockPointer:
13618     DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
13619     break;
13620   }
13621 
13622   // Finally, we can recurse.
13623   ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
13624   if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13625   E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get());
13626 
13627   // Bind a temporary if necessary.
13628   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
13629 }
13630 
13631 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
13632   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
13633   if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13634     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
13635       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
13636     return ExprError();
13637   }
13638 
13639   // Rewrite the method result type if available.
13640   if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
13641     assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
13642     Method->setReturnType(DestType);
13643   }
13644 
13645   // Change the type of the message.
13646   E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
13647   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
13648 
13649   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
13650 }
13651 
13652 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
13653   // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
13654   if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) {
13655     assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13656     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13657 
13658     E->setType(DestType);
13659 
13660     // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
13661     DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
13662 
13663     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13664     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13665 
13666     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
13667     return E;
13668   } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
13669     assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13670     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13671 
13672     assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType()));
13673 
13674     E->setType(DestType);
13675 
13676     // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such.
13677     DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType);
13678 
13679     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13680     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13681 
13682     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
13683     return E;
13684   } else {
13685     llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!");
13686   }
13687 }
13688 
13689 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
13690   ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
13691   QualType Type = DestType;
13692 
13693   // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
13694 
13695   //  - functions
13696   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
13697     if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
13698       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13699       ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
13700       if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13701       return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type,
13702                                  CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue);
13703     }
13704 
13705     if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
13706       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
13707         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
13708       return ExprError();
13709     }
13710     if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
13711       // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in
13712       // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown
13713       // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine.
13714       QualType FDT = FD->getType();
13715       const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>();
13716       const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
13717       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
13718       if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) {
13719         SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
13720         FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(),
13721                                       FD->getDeclContext(),
13722                                       Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(),
13723                                       DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
13724                                       SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/,
13725                                       FD->hasPrototype(),
13726                                       false/*isConstexprSpecified*/);
13727 
13728         if (FD->getQualifier())
13729           NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc());
13730 
13731         SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
13732         for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
13733           ParmVarDecl *Param =
13734             S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI);
13735           Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
13736           Params.push_back(Param);
13737         }
13738         NewFD->setParams(Params);
13739         DRE->setDecl(NewFD);
13740         VD = DRE->getDecl();
13741       }
13742     }
13743 
13744     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
13745       if (MD->isInstance()) {
13746         ValueKind = VK_RValue;
13747         Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
13748       }
13749 
13750     // Function references aren't l-values in C.
13751     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13752       ValueKind = VK_RValue;
13753 
13754   //  - variables
13755   } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
13756     if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
13757       Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
13758     } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
13759       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
13760         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
13761       return ExprError();
13762     }
13763 
13764   //  - nothing else
13765   } else {
13766     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
13767       << VD << E->getSourceRange();
13768     return ExprError();
13769   }
13770 
13771   // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but
13772   // also really dangerous.
13773   VD->setType(DestType);
13774   E->setType(Type);
13775   E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
13776   return E;
13777 }
13778 
13779 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type.  We intentionally only
13780 /// trigger this for C-style casts.
13781 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
13782                                      Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
13783                                      ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
13784   // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
13785   ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
13786   if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13787 
13788   CastExpr = result.get();
13789   VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
13790   CastKind = CK_NoOp;
13791 
13792   return CastExpr;
13793 }
13794 
13795 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) {
13796   return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E);
13797 }
13798 
13799 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,
13800                                     Expr *arg, QualType &paramType) {
13801   // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of
13802   // any sort, just do default argument promotion.
13803   ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens());
13804   if (!castArg) {
13805     ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg);
13806     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13807     paramType = result.get()->getType();
13808     return result;
13809   }
13810 
13811   // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast.
13812   assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType());
13813   paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten();
13814 
13815   // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type.
13816   InitializedEntity entity =
13817     InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType,
13818                                            /*consumed*/ false);
13819   return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg);
13820 }
13821 
13822 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
13823   Expr *orig = E;
13824   unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
13825   while (true) {
13826     E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
13827     if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
13828       E = call->getCallee();
13829       diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
13830     } else {
13831       break;
13832     }
13833   }
13834 
13835   SourceLocation loc;
13836   NamedDecl *d;
13837   if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
13838     loc = ref->getLocation();
13839     d = ref->getDecl();
13840   } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
13841     loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
13842     d = mem->getMemberDecl();
13843   } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
13844     diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
13845     loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
13846     d = msg->getMethodDecl();
13847     if (!d) {
13848       S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
13849         << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
13850         << orig->getSourceRange();
13851       return ExprError();
13852     }
13853   } else {
13854     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
13855       << E->getSourceRange();
13856     return ExprError();
13857   }
13858 
13859   S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
13860 
13861   // Never recoverable.
13862   return ExprError();
13863 }
13864 
13865 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
13866 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
13867 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
13868   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
13869     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
13870     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
13871     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
13872     ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E);
13873     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13874     E = Result.get();
13875   }
13876 
13877   const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType();
13878   if (!placeholderType) return E;
13879 
13880   switch (placeholderType->getKind()) {
13881 
13882   // Overloaded expressions.
13883   case BuiltinType::Overload: {
13884     // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
13885     // This is obligatory.
13886     ExprResult result = E;
13887     if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) {
13888       return result;
13889 
13890     // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
13891     } else {
13892       tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
13893                            /*complain*/ true);
13894       return result;
13895     }
13896   }
13897 
13898   // Bound member functions.
13899   case BuiltinType::BoundMember: {
13900     ExprResult result = E;
13901     tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function),
13902                          /*complain*/ true);
13903     return result;
13904   }
13905 
13906   // ARC unbridged casts.
13907   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: {
13908     Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
13909     diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast);
13910     return realCast;
13911   }
13912 
13913   // Expressions of unknown type.
13914   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
13915     return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
13916 
13917   // Pseudo-objects.
13918   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
13919     return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E);
13920 
13921   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: {
13922     // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr.
13923     auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
13924     if (DRE) {
13925       auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13926       if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) {
13927         E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()),
13928                               CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
13929         return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy,
13930                                       VK_RValue, SourceLocation());
13931       }
13932     }
13933 
13934     Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use);
13935     return ExprError();
13936   }
13937 
13938   // Everything else should be impossible.
13939 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \
13940   case BuiltinType::Id:
13941 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
13942 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
13943     break;
13944   }
13945 
13946   llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!");
13947 }
13948 
13949 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
13950   if (E->isTypeDependent())
13951     return true;
13952   if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
13953     return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
13954   return false;
13955 }
13956 
13957 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals.
13958 ExprResult
13959 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
13960   assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) &&
13961          "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!");
13962   QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy;
13963   if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) {
13964     LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc,
13965                         Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
13966     if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) {
13967       NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl();
13968       if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND))
13969         Context.setBOOLDecl(TD);
13970     }
13971   }
13972   if (Context.getBOOLDecl())
13973     BoolT = Context.getBOOLType();
13974   return new (Context)
13975       ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc);
13976 }
13977